Advanced Hybrid System
Installation Manual
MODEL NO.
KX-TA624
Please read this manual before connecting
the Advanced Hybrid System.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Precautions
FOR YOUR SAFETY PLEASE READ THE FOLLOWING TEXT CAREFULLY.
This appliance is supplied with a moulded three pin mains plug for your safety and convenience.
A 5 amp fuse is fitted in this plug.
Should the fuse need to be replaced please ensure that the replacement fuse has a rating of 5
amps and that it is approved by ASTA or BSI to BS1362.
Check for the ASTA mark
or the BSI mark
on the body of the fuse.
If the plug contains a removable fuse cover you must ensure that it is refitted when the fuse is
replaced.
If you lose the fuse cover the plug must not be used until a replacement cover is obtained.
A replacement fuse cover can be purchased from your local Panasonic Dealer.
IF THE FITTED MOULDED PLUG IS UNSUITABLE FOR THE SOCKET OUTLET IN
YOUR HOME THEN THE FUSE SHOULD BE REMOVED AND THE PLUG CUT OFF AND
DISPOSED OF SAFELY.
THERE IS A DANGER OF SEVERE ELECTRICAL SHOCK IF THE CUT OFF PLUG IS
INSERTED INTO ANY 13 AMP SOCKET.
If a new plug is to be fitted please observe the wiring code as shown below.
If in any doubt please consult a qualified electrician.
WARNING : THIS APPLIANCE MUST BE EARTHED.
IMPORTANT : The wires in this mains leads are coloured in accordance with the following
code:
Green-and-yellow: Earth
Blue:
Brown:
Neutral
Live
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may not correspond with the
coloured markings identifying the terminals in your plug, proceed as follows.
The wire which is coloured GREEN-AND-YELLOW must be connected to the terminal in the
plug which is marked with the letter E or by the safety earth symbol
GREEN-AND-YELLOW.
or coloured GREEN or
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the
letter N or coloured BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the
letter L or coloured RED.
How to replace the fuse : Open the-fuse compartment with a screwdriver and replace the fuse
and fuse cover.
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Precautions
This equipment should be used on PSTN lines requiring 2-wire Loop calling unguarded clearing
with Loop Disconnect or DTMF address signalling.
The equipment must be connected to direct extension lines and a payphone should not be
connected as an extension.
Operation in Power Failure
In the event of a power failure, two single line telephones connected to extension ports 01 and 09
will be directly connected to the following Exchange lines:
Exchange line 1 : extension port 01
Exchange line 4 : extension port 09
• Set the Dialling Mode (Tone or Pulse) of your telephone, according to the Exchange line.
• 999 and 112 can be dialled on the apparatus for the purpose of making outgoing calls to the BT
emergency (999) and (112) service.
Satisfactory performance can not be guaranteed for every allowed combination of host and
subsidiary apparatus.
999 and 112 can be dialled on the apparatus after accessing the Exchange line for the purpose of
making outgoing calls to the BT emergency (999) and (112) service.
During dialling, this apparatus may tinkle the bells of other telephones using the same line. this
is not a fault and we advise you not to call Fault Repair Service.
‘Prevention of access by user. This apparatus is intended to be accessible only to authorised
personnel. This apparatus must be installed in a locked room or similar environment, such that
user access is prevented. Failure to prevent such user access will invalidate any approval given to
this apparatus.’
Caution:
Do not push the PAUSE button more than twice following the initial access digit (or digits).
Failure to comply with this requirement may result in unsatisfactory operation.
Notice:
This PBX should only be used on B•T lines on which specific BT services or facilities are
provided.
CAUTION
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer.
Dispose of used batteries according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Precautions
• The apparatus is designed to be installed and operated under controlled conditions of ambient
temperature and a relative humidity not greater than 60 %.
• Avoid installing the apparatus in damp or humid environments, such as bathrooms or
swimming pools.
• The apparatus shall not be exposed to dripping or splashing.
• Keep the unit away from heating appliances and electrical noise generating devices such as
fluorescent lamps, motors and televisions. These noise sources can interfere with the
performance of the Advanced Hybrid System.
• This unit should be kept free of dust, moisture, high temperature (more than 40 ˚C) and
vibration, and should not be exposed to direct sunlight.
• Never attempt to insert wires, pins, etc. into the vents or other holes of this unit.
• If there is any trouble, disconnect the unit from the telephone line. Plug a single line
telephone into the telephone line. If the telephone operates properly, do not reconnect your
system to the line until the system has been repaired. If the telephone does not operate
properly, chances are that the problem is in the telephone network, and not in your system.
• Do not use benzine, thinner, or the like, or any abrasive powder to clean the cabinet. Wipe it
with a soft cloth.
WARNING
THIS UNIT MAY ONLY BE INSTALLED AND SERVED BY QUALIFIED
SERVICE PERSONNEL.
WHEN A FAILURE OCCURS WHICH RESULTS IN THE INTERNAL PARTS
BECOMING ACCESSIBLE, DISCONNECT THE POWER SUPPLY CORD
IMMEDIATELY AND RETURN THIS UNIT TO YOUR DEALER.
DISCONNECT THE TELECOM CONNECTION BEFORE DISCONNECTING THE
POWER CONNECTION PRIOR TO RELOCATING THE EQUIPMENT, AND
RECONNECT THE POWER FIRST.
THIS UNIT IS EQUIPPED WITH AN EARTHING CONTACT PLUG. FOR SAFETY
REASONS THIS PLUG MUST ONLY BE CONNECTED TO AN EARTHING
CONTACT SOCKET WHICH HAS BEEN INSTALLED ACCORDING TO
REGULATIONS.
THE POWER SUPPLY CORD IS USED AS THE MAIN DISCONNECT DEVICE,
ENSURE THAT THE SOCKET-OUTLET IS LOCATED/INSTALLED NEAR THE
EQUIPMENT AND IS EASILY ACCESSIBLE.
TO PREVENT THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE
THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Precautions
For your future reference
SERIAL NO.
DATE OF PURCHASE
(found on the bottom of the unit)
NAME OF DEALER
DEALER’S ADDRESS
Note • This Installation Manual does not show the complete model number that indicates
the country where your equipment should be used. The model number of your unit
is found on the label affixed to the unit.
MODEL NO. – – – – – – – –
(label)
APPROVED for connection to
telecommunication systems
specified in the instructions for
use subject to the conditions set
out in them.
610186
Warning:
This is a Class A Product. In a domestic environment this product may cause radio interference in
which case the user may be required to take adequate measures.
This unit complies with the EU Directives.
“Electrical equipment for use within certain voltage limits.”
“Electromagnetic compatibility” (basic standard)
“Electromagnetic compatibility” (amendment)
“Marking”
73 / 23 / EEC
89 / 336 / EEC
92 / 31 / EEC
93 / 68 / EEC
The CE mark on this unit certifies compliance with the above mentioned Directives.
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introduction
Structure of the Manual
This manual consists of the following sections:
Section 1. Basic System Construction
Provides general information on the system including connection diagrams.
Section 2. Installation
Contains the system installation and wiring instructions, as well as how to install the
optional cards.
Section 3. Features
Describes the optional and programmable features in alphabetical order. It also provides
information about the conditions, required System Programming, connection references,
related features and operating instructions references for every feature.
Section 4. System Programming
Describes the steps required to assign features to extensions or to the system.
Section 5. Appendix
Provides specifications and the default values of the System Programming.
Section 6. Troubleshooting
Provides information for system and telephone troubleshooting.
Section 7. Programming Tables
Provides programming tables for user-programmed data.
Description of the Symbols Mainly Used in this manual
Additional information and conditions.
!
☞
The feature or program references.
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Section 1 Basic System Construction
Section 2 Installation
2.1 Before Installation................................................................................. 2-2
2.2 Unpacking .............................................................................................. 2-4
2.3 Names and Locations............................................................................ 2-4
2.4 Wall Mounting....................................................................................... 2-5
2.5 Frame Ground Connection .................................................................. 2-6
2.6 Opening the Top Front Cover.............................................................. 2-6
2.7 Exchange Line Connection................................................................... 2-7
2.8 Extension Connection ........................................................................... 2-10
2.9 External Pager (Paging Equipment) Connection............................... 2-12
2.10 External Music Connection.................................................................. 2-13
2.11 Parallelled Telephone Connection ....................................................... 2-14
2.12 Polarity Sensitive Telephone Connection............................................ 2-15
2.13 Printer and PC Connection.................................................................. 2-16
2.14 Location of Optional Cards.................................................................. 2-19
2.15 OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation.............................................. 2-19
2.16 Doorphone and Door Opener Connection.......................................... 2-21
2.17 Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474) ......................... 2-25
2.18 Auxiliary Connection for Power Failure Transfer............................. 2-30
2.19 Securing the Cords................................................................................ 2-31
2.20 Closing the Front Cover ....................................................................... 2-31
2.21 Starting the System for the First Time ............................................... 2-32
2.22 System Restart....................................................................................... 2-33
2.23 System Data Clear................................................................................. 2-34
Section 3 Features
A
Absent Message Capability................................................................ 3-2
Account Code Entry........................................................................... 3-3
Alternate Calling – Ring/Voice .......................................................... 3-3
Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-On) ............................................... 3-4
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number........................................ 3-4
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)..................................................... 3-5
Busy Extension Signalling ................................................................. 3-10
Call Barring ........................................................................................ 3-11
Call Barring — Extension Lock Boundary Class.............................. 3-13
Call Barring for System Speed Dialling ........................................... 3-13
Call Barring Override by Account Codes .......................................... 3-14
Call Forwarding.................................................................................. 3-15
Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection .................................. 3-15
Call Park ............................................................................................. 3-16
Call Pickup ......................................................................................... 3-17
Call Splitting....................................................................................... 3-17
B
C
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Call Transfer – to Exchange Line ...................................................... 3-18
Call Transfer – to Extension............................................................... 3-18
Call Waiting........................................................................................ 3-19
Conference (3-party) .......................................................................... 3-20
Conference (5-party) .......................................................................... 3-21
Data Line Security.............................................................................. 3-21
Date and Time Setting........................................................................ 3-22
Direct In Line (DIL)........................................................................... 3-22
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)............................................... 3-22
Display Contrast Adjustment (KX-T7130 only)................................ 3-28
Distinctive Dial Tones ........................................................................ 3-28
Do Not Disturb (DND)....................................................................... 3-29
Door Opener....................................................................................... 3-30
Doorphone Call .................................................................................. 3-30
DSS Console....................................................................................... 3-31
Emergency Call .................................................................................. 3-32
Exchange Line Ringing Selection...................................................... 3-32
Executive Busy Override.................................................................... 3-33
Extension Button Confirmation (KX-T7130 only)............................ 3-33
Extension Feature Clear ..................................................................... 3-34
Extension Group................................................................................. 3-35
Extension Hunting.............................................................................. 3-36
Extension Lock................................................................................... 3-36
Extension Password / System Password ............................................ 3-37
External Feature Access ..................................................................... 3-38
Flexible Buttons.................................................................................. 3-39
Handsfree Answerback....................................................................... 3-40
Handsfree Operation........................................................................... 3-40
Hold .................................................................................................... 3-40
Host PBX Access................................................................................ 3-41
Intercept Routing ............................................................................... 3-42
Intercom Calling................................................................................. 3-42
Language Selection ............................................................................ 3-43
Limited Call Duration ........................................................................ 3-43
Line Access Keys ............................................................................... 3-43
Log-In/Log-Out .................................................................................. 3-44
Message Waiting................................................................................. 3-45
Microphone Mute............................................................................... 3-45
Music on Hold / Background Music (BGM) ..................................... 3-46
One-Touch Dialling ............................................................................ 3-46
Operator / Manager Extension ........................................................... 3-47
Operator Call ...................................................................................... 3-47
Outgoing Message (OGM)................................................................. 3-48
Outside Calling................................................................................... 3-52
D
E
F
H
I
L
M
O
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
P
Paging ................................................................................................. 3-53
Parallelled Telephone Connection...................................................... 3-54
Personal Speed Dialling ..................................................................... 3-54
Pickup Dialling................................................................................... 3-55
Polarity Reverse Detection................................................................. 3-55
Power Failure Transfer ....................................................................... 3-56
Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming ........................................... 3-56
Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing............................................ 3-57
Proprietary Telephone Setting Data Default Set ................................ 3-57
Pulse to Tone Conversion................................................................... 3-58
Recall.................................................................................................. 3-58
Recall Button on a Single Line Telephone......................................... 3-59
Receiving Calls................................................................................... 3-59
Redial.................................................................................................. 3-60
Ringing Pattern Selection................................................................... 3-60
Room Monitor .................................................................................... 3-61
Secret Dialling.................................................................................... 3-62
Self-Extension Number Confirmation (KX-T7130 only).................. 3-62
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)...................................... 3-63
System Data Default Set .................................................................... 3-64
System Speed Dialling ....................................................................... 3-65
Timed Reminder................................................................................. 3-65
Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service....................................................... 3-66
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD) ...................................................... 3-67
Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100 ............................................ 3-71
Volume Control ................................................................................. 3-74
Walking COS...................................................................................... 3-74
R
S
T
U
V
W
Section 4 System Programming
4.1 Before System Programming ............................................................... 4-2
4.2 System Programming............................................................................ 4-5
[000] Date and Time Setting.............................................................. 4-5
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry................................................... 4-5
[002] System Password...................................................................... 4-6
[003] DSS Console Port Assignment ................................................ 4-7
[004] Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS Console...................... 4-7
[005] One-Touch Transfer Using a DSS Button ............................... 4-8
[006] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing Mode ................. 4-8
[007] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time .......................... 4-9
[008] Operator Assignment .............................................................. 4-9
[009] Extension Number Assignment .............................................. 4-10
[010] LCD Time Display Selection................................................... 4-11
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting...................................... 4-12
[012] Alternative Feature Numbering Plan ....................................... 4-13
[100] Hunting Group Set ................................................................... 4-14
10
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
[101] Hunting Type............................................................................ 4-14
[102] Voice Mail Port for KX-TVP100............................................. 4-15
[103] DTMF Integration for KX-TVP100......................................... 4-16
[104] Hold Mode Selection ............................................................... 4-17
[105] Conference Tone ...................................................................... 4-17
[106] External Paging Access Tone................................................... 4-18
[107] DTMF Receiver Check ............................................................ 4-18
[108] Recall Mode for a Locked Extension ...................................... 4-18
[109] CO Indicator Assignment......................................................... 4-19
[110] Recall Key Mode...................................................................... 4-19
[111] Hold Music Selection............................................................... 4-20
[112] DSS Console Indication Mode ................................................ 4-20
[115] Extension Ringing Pattern Selection ....................................... 4-21
[116] Conference Pattern Selection................................................... 4-21
[117] Call Pickup Tone...................................................................... 4-22
[118] Pulse Restriction ...................................................................... 4-22
[119] Redialling after Pulse to Tone Conversion .............................. 4-22
[120] Bell Frequency ......................................................................... 4-23
[121] Automatic Exchange Line Access Number Selection ............. 4-23
[122] Automatic Rotation for Exchange Line Access....................... 4-23
[123] Break Ratio .............................................................................. 4-24
[124] SLT Ringing Mode Selection................................................... 4-24
[125] Call Barring Check for
and #.............................................. 4-24
[126] DSS Off-Hook Mode ............................................................... 4-25
[127] Pickup Group Set ..................................................................... 4-25
[200] Hold Recall Time ..................................................................... 4-26
[201] Transfer Recall Time................................................................ 4-26
[202] Call Forwarding Start Time ..................................................... 4-27
[203] Pickup Dial Delay Time........................................................... 4-27
[204] Call Duration Count Start Time .............................................. 4-28
[206] Dialling Start Time................................................................... 4-28
[207] Recall Timing Range Selection................................................ 4-29
[208] Interdigit Time.......................................................................... 4-29
[210] DTMF Time ............................................................................. 4-30
[211] No Dial Disconnection............................................................. 4-30
[212] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit....................................... 4-31
[213] Bell Off Detection.................................................................... 4-31
[300] Carrier Excepted Code Assignment......................................... 4-32
[301] Call Barring – System Speed Dialling Boundary Class.......... 4-32
[302]-[305] Call Barring – Classes 2 through 5 Denied Codes........ 4-33
[306] Call Barring – Exception Codes .............................................. 4-34
[309] Emergency Dial Number Set ................................................... 4-34
[310] Account Codes ......................................................................... 4-35
[311] Automatic Pause Insertion Codes............................................ 4-35
[312] Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class ..................... 4-36
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
[350] ARS Selection.......................................................................... 4-37
[351]-[354] Routes 1 through 4 Selection Codes (Leading Digits).. 4-37
[355]-[358] Routes 1 through 4 Exception Codes ........................... 4-38
[359] 1st Carrier Selection Code (BT Line Access Code)................ 4-38
[360] ARS Modification – Removed Digits...................................... 4-39
[361] ARS Modification – Added Number ....................................... 4-39
[362] ARS Dial Tone Pattern Selection............................................. 4-40
[363] ARS Interdigit Time................................................................. 4-40
[364] ARS Trunk Group.................................................................... 4-41
[381]-[384] Routes 1 through 4 Authorisation Codes....................... 4-42
[385]-[388] Routes 1 through 4 Itemised Bill................................... 4-43
[389] Itemised Bill Code Assignment ............................................... 4-43
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment.................................. 4-44
[401] Dial Mode ................................................................................ 4-44
[402] Pulse Speed Selection .............................................................. 4-45
[403] Host PBX Access Codes.......................................................... 4-45
[404] Trunk Group Assignment......................................................... 4-46
[405]-[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment
—Day/Night/Lunch ....................................................... 4-47
[408]-[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch ....... 4-48
[411]-[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch....... 4-49
[414]-[416] Exchange Line Mode —Day/Night/Lunch.................... 4-50
[417] Pause Time ............................................................................... 4-51
[418] Recall Time .............................................................................. 4-52
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access ........................ 4-52
[420] Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal......................................... 4-53
[421] CPC Detection for Outgoing Calls .......................................... 4-54
[422] Disconnect Time ...................................................................... 4-54
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection ............................... 4-55
[424] Reverse (Polarity) Circuit Assignment .................................... 4-56
[500] DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection ............................... 4-57
[501] DISA Built-in Auto Attendant ................................................ 4-58
[502] OGM Mode Selection.............................................................. 4-59
[503] FAX Connection....................................................................... 4-60
[504] DISA Delayed Answer Time ................................................... 4-60
[505] DISA Waiting Time after OGM............................................... 4-60
[506] DISA Busy Mode..................................................................... 4-61
[507] DISA Intercept Mode............................................................... 4-61
[508] DISA Ringing Time before Intercept ...................................... 4-62
[509] DISA Ringing Time after Intercept ......................................... 4-62
[510] DISA No Dial Mode ............................................................... 4-63
[513] Cyclic Tone Detection.............................................................. 4-63
[514] FAX Tone Detection ................................................................ 4-64
[515] Intercept Time for Internal DISA ............................................ 4-64
12
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
[516] DISA Incoming Assignment.................................................... 4-65
[517] DISA AA Wait Time................................................................ 4-65
[519] DISA OGM Mute Time ........................................................... 4-66
[520] UCD Group.............................................................................. 4-66
[521] UCD Busy Waiting Time ......................................................... 4-66
[522] UCD OGM Message Interval Time......................................... 4-67
[523] UCD Busy Mode...................................................................... 4-67
[524] UCD Intercept Mode................................................................ 4-68
[525] UCD Ringing Time before Intercept ....................................... 4-68
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept .......................................... 4-68
[600] Extension Group Assignment .................................................. 4-69
[601]-[603] Call Barring – Class of Service Assignment
—Day/Night/Lunch ....................................................... 4-69
[604] Extension Name Setting........................................................... 4-70
[605] Account Code Entry Mode ...................................................... 4-71
[606] Call Transfer to an Exchange Line .......................................... 4-72
[607] Call Forwarding to an Exchange Line..................................... 4-72
[608] Executive Busy Override ......................................................... 4-73
[609] Do Not Disturb Override ......................................................... 4-73
[610] Parallelled Telephone Connection............................................ 4-74
[611] TAM (Telephone Answering Machine) Extension .................. 4-74
[612] Room Monitor Assignment...................................................... 4-75
[613] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit Selection....................... 4-75
[614] Internal Pulse Detection........................................................... 4-76
[615] LCD Language Assignment..................................................... 4-77
[700]-[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch .. 4-78
[703]-[705] Door Opener Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch ............. 4-79
[706] Doorphone Ringing / Tone Pattern Selection .......................... 4-80
[707] Doorphone Access Tone Selection........................................... 4-80
[708] Doorphone Ringing Time ........................................................ 4-81
[709] Door Opener Time ................................................................... 4-81
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters......................... 4-82
[801] SMDR Parameter ..................................................................... 4-83
[802] Incoming/Outgoing Call Selection for Printing....................... 4-83
[803] Secret Speed Dialling / One-Touch Dialling Printing ............. 4-84
[804] System Data Dump .................................................................. 4-84
[805] SMDR Account Code Selection .............................................. 4-85
[806] SMDR Language Assignment.................................................. 4-86
[998] ROM Version............................................................................ 4-86
[999] System Data Clear.................................................................... 4-87
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Section 5 Appendix
5.1 Default Values ........................................................................................ 5-2
5.2 Specifications ......................................................................................... 5-7
Section 6 Troubleshooting
6.1 While Installing ..................................................................................... 6-2
6.2 While Connecting.................................................................................. 6-3
6.3 While Operating.................................................................................... 6-4
Section 7 Programming Tables
Template
14
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 1
Basic System Construction
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1
Basic System Construction
The KX-TA624 has a basic capacity of 8 extensions and 3 exchange lines. It is capable of
supporting Panasonic analogue proprietary telephones, and single line devices such as single
line telephones, facsimiles and data terminals.
To expand its capabilities, the system can be equipped with optional components or
customer-supplied peripherals such as an external speaker, external music source (e.g. a radio)
and door opener.
System Connection Diagram
6 Exchange Lines
to exchange lines 1 – 3 (initial)
to exchange lines 4 – 6 (additional)
(Lightning Protectors)
External Music Source
Amplifier
Speaker
Printer
or
Computer
Extension ports 01 – 08 (initial)
Extension ports 09 – 24 (additional)
24 Extensions
(two pair)
(one pair)
(one pair)
(two pair)
Single Line Telephone
KX-T7020
(two pair)
KX-T7130
Data Terminal
KX-T7040
(two pair)
Door Openers
(one pair)
Panasonic
Cordless Phone
(one pair)
KX-T7050
Panasonic
Panasonic
Panasonic
• We recommend connecting a display
proprietary telephone at extension port 01.
• Parallel connection of telephones is
Telephone Answering Machine
with Facsimile
!
(one pair)
possible. ( 2.11, Parallelled Telephone
☞
Connection)
• A proprietary telephone cannot be
connected to extension ports 17 through 24.
Only a single line telephone (SLT) can be
connected.
Doorphones
KX-T30865
Voice Processing System
1-2
Basic System Construction
: needs optional card.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 2
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.1
Before Installation
Please read the following notes concerning installation and connection before installing the
system and terminal equipment.
Safety Installation Instructions
When installing telephone wiring, basic safety precautions should always be followed to
reduce the risk of fire, electric shock and injury to persons, including the following:
1. Never install telephone wiring during a lightning storm.
2. Never install telephone ports in wet locations unless the port is specifically designed for
wet locations.
3. Never touch uninsulated telephone wires or terminals unless the telephone line has been
disconnected at the network interface.
4. Use caution when installing or modifying telephone lines.
Installation Precautions
This system is designed for wall mounting only. Avoid installing in the following places.
(Doing so may result in malfunction, noise, or discolouration.)
1. In direct sunlight and hot, cold, or humid places. (Temperature range: 0 °C – 40 °C)
2. Sulphuric gases produced in areas where there are thermal springs, etc. may damage the
equipment or contacts.
3. Places in which shocks or vibrations are frequent or strong.
4. Dusty places, or places where water or oil may come into contact with the system.
5. Near high-frequency generating devices such as sewing machines or electric welders.
6. On or near computers, telexes, or other office equipment, as well as microwave ovens or
air conditioners. (It is preferable not to install the system in the same room with the above
equipment.)
7. Install at least 1.8 m away from radios and televisions. (Both the system and Panasonic
proprietary telephones)
8. Do not obstruct area around the system (for reasons of maintenance and inspection — be
especially careful to allow space for cooling above and at the sides of the system).
Wiring Precautions
Be sure to follow these instructions when wiring the unit:
1. Do not wire the telephone cable in parallel with an AC power source, computer, telex, etc.
If the cables are run near those wires, shield the cables with metal tubing or use shielded
cables and ground the shields.
2. If cables are run on the floor, use protectors to prevent the wires from being stepped on.
Avoid wiring under carpets.
3. Avoid using the same power supply outlet for computers, telexes, and other office
equipment. Otherwise, the system operation may be interrupted by the induction noise
from such equipment.
2-2
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.1
Before Installation
4. Please use one pair telephone wire for extension connection of (telephone) equipment
such as single line telephones, data terminals, answering machines, computers, voice
processing systems, etc., except Panasonic proprietary telephones (e.g. KX-T7130).
5. Unplug the system during wiring. After all of the wiring is completed, plug in the
system.
6. Mis-wiring may cause the system to operate improperly. Refer to Section 6.1 “While
Installing” and Section 6.2 “While Connecting”.
7. If an extension does not operate properly, disconnect the telephone from the extension
line and then connect again, or turn off the Power Switch of the system and then on
again.
8. The system is equipped with a 3-wire grounding type plug. This is a safety feature. If
you are unable to insert the plug into the outlet, contact your electrician to replace your
obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the purpose of the grounding-type plug.
9. Exchange lines should be installed with lightning protectors. For details, refer to Section
2.7 “Exchange Line Connection”, Installing Lightning Protectors.
Warning:
Static sensitive devices
are used. To protect
POWER
printed circuit boards
from static electricity, do
not touch connectors
indicated to the left. To
discharge body static,
touch ground or wear a
grounding strap.
Side View
Warning: Static sensitive connectors
Installation
2-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Unpacking
Unpack the box and check the items below.
Main Unit
Music Source Connector
Order No. PQJP1E1Z
1
1
1
1
1
AC Cord
Order No. PSWAT206E
Installation Manual
Order No. PSQX1708Y
Telephone Line Cords
(2-conductor wiring)
Order No. PSJA1066Z
Operating Instructions
Order No. PSQX1709Y
3
8
Telephone Line Cords
(4-conductor wiring)
Order No. PQJA151Z
Operating Instructions for
the Caller ID Card
Order No. PSQX1744Y
1
Screws (Wall Mounting)
Order No. PQHE5004Z
SLT User Guide
Order No. PSQX1753Z
3
3
1
2
1
1
Washers (Wall Mounting)
Order No. XWG35FY
System Clear Leaflet
Order No. PSQW1412Y
Pager Connector
Order No. PQJP1E1Z
Feature Number Leaflet
Order No. PSQW1472Y
Optional Cards (For your reference)
KX-TA62460
KX-TA62474
KX-TA62477
Screws
Order No. XYN3+F12FN
Screws
Order No. XYN3+F8
Extension Bolts
Order No. PSHE1051Z
1
2
2
2
2
1
Terminal Boxes
Order No. PQJS1T30Z
Extension Connectors
Order No. PSJP36A67Z
Extension Connectors
Order No. PSJP36A67Z
2
Telephone Line Cords
(4-conductor wiring)
Order No. PQJA48W
Spacer
Order No. PSHR1172Z
2
2.3
Names and Locations
Strap (for cables)
Paging Port
Extension Ports
Exchange Line Ports
External Music Port
POWER
Power Switch
Serial Interface
(RS-232C)
Protective Earth Terminal
AC Inlet
Side View
Power Indicator
2-4
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.4
Wall Mounting
This set is designed for wall mounting only. The wall where the main unit is to be mounted
must be able to support the weight of the main unit. If screws other than the ones supplied
are used, use screws with the same diameter as the ones enclosed.
Mounting on a Wooden Wall
1. Place the template (on the last page) on the wall to mark the screw positions.
Template
2. Install the screws (included) into the wall.
Wooden
Wall
Drive the screw
to this position
3. Hook the main unit on the screw heads.
Installation
2-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.5
Frame Ground Connection
IMPORTANT!!!
Connect the frame of the main unit to
the ground.
1. Loosen the screw.
2. Insert the grounding wire (user-
supplied).
To the ground
Screw
3. Tighten the screw.
4. Connect the grounding wire to the ground.
2.6
Opening the Top Front Cover
1. Loosen the screw.
2. Remove the top front cover.
Top front cover
Screw
• The screw cannot be removed from the cover.
!
2-6
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.7
Exchange Line Connection
Connection
1. Insert the modular plugs of the telephone line cords (2-conductor wiring) into the ports
(CO 1 through 3) on the system.
2. Connect the line cords to the terminal board or the ports from the Local Exchange.
View of TEL Port (Exchange Line)
A: Tip
B: Ring
A B
To Terminal Board or Ports
from the Local Exchange
POWER
• Exchange Line ports are at TNV.
!
Installing Lightning Protectors
A lightning protector is a device to be installed on an exchange line to prevent a dangerous
surge from entering the building and damaging the equipment.
A dangerous surge can occur if a telephone line comes in contact with a power line. Problems
due to lightning surges have been steadily increasing with the development of electronic
equipment.
In many countries, there are regulations requiring the installation of a lightning protector. A
lightning strike to a telephone cable which is 10 m above ground can be as high as 200 000 V.
This system should be installed with lightning protectors. In addition, grounding (connection
to earth ground) is very important to protect the system (☞ 2.5, Frame Ground Connection).
Installation
2-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.7
Exchange Line Connection
Installation
CO
CO
CO
Lightning
Protectors
System
Terminal
Board
EXTN.
Protective
Earth
Terminal
EXTN.
TEL
EXTN.
TEL
Frame Ground
CO:
Exchange line
Ground
EXTN.: Extension line
TEL: Telephone
Outside Installation
If you install an extension outside of the main building, the following precautions are
recommended:
(1) Install the extension wire underground.
(2) Use a conduit to protect the wire.
(Main Building)
Protectors
CO
(Another Building)
CO
SLT
PT
CO
Main
Distribution
Frame
EXTN
Main
Unit
Lightning
Protector
EXTN
EXTN
EXTN
TEL
TEL
Earth
Note • The lightning protector for an extension is different from that for CO.
2-8
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.7
Exchange Line Connection
Installation of an Earth Rod
Lightning
Protectors
CO
Grounding Wire
System
(Underground)
Rod
1) Installation location of the earth rod . . . . . . Near the protector
2) Check obstructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . None
3) Composition of the earth rod . . . . . . . . . . . Metal
4) Depth of the earth rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . More than 50 cm
5) Size of the grounding wire . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thickness more than ø1.6 mm
Note • The above example is only a recommendation.
• The length of the earth rod and required depth depend on the composition of the soil.
Installation
2-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.8
Extension Connection
Extension ports 01 through 08 can be used for all kinds of telephones.
Telephone Wiring
The maximum length of the extension line cord (twisted cable) which connects the system
and the extension is as follows.
ø 0.5 mm (26 AWG); Under 140 m
ø 0.6 mm (24 AWG); Under 229 m
ø 0.8 mm (22 AWG); Under 360 m
(Extension Loop Limit: 40 Ω)
Proprietary Telephone
Single Line Telephone
ø 0.5 mm (26 AWG); Under 698 m
ø 0.6 mm (24 AWG); Under 1128 m
ø 0.8 mm (22 AWG); Under 1798 m
(Extension Loop Limit: 600 Ω including set)
ø 0.5 mm (26 AWG); Under 140 m
ø 0.6 mm (24 AWG); Under 229 m
ø 0.8 mm (22 AWG); Under 360 m
(Extension Loop Limit: 40 Ω)
DSS Console
(KX-T7040)
2 or 4-conductor wiring is required for each extension as listed below. There are 4 pins
possible for connection: “T” (Tip), “R” (Ring), “L” (Low) and “H” (High).
Telephone
Wiring
1 pair wire (A,B)
Single line telephones
Proprietary telephone
(e.g., KX-T7130)
2 pair wire (L, H, A, B)
• If a telephone or answering machine with an A-A1 relay is connected to the system, set
the A-A1 relay switch on the telephone or answering machine to the OFF position.
• Extension ports are at TNV.
!
2-10
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.8
Extension Connection
Connection
Insert the modular plugs of the telephone line cords (2 or 4-conductor wiring) into the ports
(JACK 01 through 08) on the system.
View of TEL Port (Extension)
H: High
A: Tip
B: Ring
L: Low
HAB L
To extensions
(JACK 01–08)
POWER
• System extensions must be located within the same building as the KX-TA624.
!
Installation
2-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.9
External Pager (Paging Equipment) Connection
One external pager (user-supplied) can be connected to the system as illustrated below.
Use an EIAJ RC-6701 A plug (2-conductor, ø 3.5 mm in diameter).
• Output impedance: 600 Ω
Maximum length of the cable
ø 0.8 mm – ø 1.3 mm: Under 10 m
Paging Port
POWER
PAGING
Speaker
Amplifier
Paging Equipment
• To adjust the sound level of the pager, use the volume control on the amplifier.
• Paging port is at SELV.
!
☞
• Required System Programming
Section 4.2, System Programming
[106] External Paging Access Tone
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Paging
2-12
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.10
External Music Connection
One music source, such as a radio (user-supplied), can be connected to the system as
illustrated below.
Insert the plug to the earphone/headphone port on the external music source.
Use an EIAJ RC-6701 A plug (2-conductor, ø 3.5 mm in diameter).
• Input impedance: 8 Ω
Maximum length of the cable
ø 0.8 mm – ø 1.3 mm: Under 10 m
External Music Port
EXT.
POWER
MUSIC
External Music source
• System programming for the music sources used for Music on Hold and Background
Music (BGM) is required.
• To adjust the sound level of the Music on Hold, use the volume control on the external
music source.
!
• External Music port is at SELV.
• Required System Programming
Section 4.2, System Programming
[111] Hold Music Selection
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Music on Hold / Background Music (BGM)
Installation
2-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.11
Parallelled Telephone Connection
Any single line telephone can be connected in parallel with a proprietary telephone as
follows.
Using a Modular T-Adaptor
2-conductor wiring cord
Connect pins “A” and “B”.
4-conductor wiring cord
For a proprietary telephone:
Connect pins “A”, “B”, “H” and “L”.
Proprietary Telephone
Single Line Telephone
• Required System Programming
Section 4.2, System Programming
☞
[610] Parallelled Telephone Connection
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Parallelled Telephone Connection
2-14
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.12
Polarity Sensitive Telephone Connection
If your telephone is polarity sensitive, follow the procedure below:
1. Complete all the required extension wiring.
2. Confirm that dialling can be done from all the
extensions using a touch-tone telephone.
If dialling fails, the polarity between the extension
and the system must be reversed.
3. Reverse as shown.
Extension
4. Unplug the system.
Exchange Line
Reverse here
1
4
2
5
8
3
6
7
9
0
5. Connect all exchange lines.
6. Confirm that dialling can be done on the following
extension using a touch-tone telephone.
Extension (A, B) of port 01: Exchange line 1
If dialling fails, the polarity between the system and
the exchange line must be reversed.
7. Reverse as shown.
8. Every time an extension telephone is replaced,
Extension
repeat the procedure above.
Exchange Line
1
4
2
5
8
3
6
7
9
0
Reverse here
Installation
2-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.13
Printer and PC Connection
A user-supplied printer or personal computer (PC) can be connected to the system. These
are used to print out or refer to the SMDR call records and system programming data.
Connect the printer cable or the PC cable to the Serial Interface (RS-232C) connector. The
cable must be shielded and the maximum length is 2 m.
Serial Interface
(RS-232C) (D-SUB, 9-pin)
Printer
or
Computer
Arrange the cables so that the printer will be connected to the system as shown in the
appropriate chart on the following page.
The pin configuration of the Serial Interface (RS-232C) Connector is as follows.
Pin
No.
2
Signal Name
Circuit Type
EIA CCITT
RXD
Received Data
BB
104
3
4
TXD
DTR
Transmitted Data
Data Terminal Ready
BA
CD
103
108.2
5
6
SG
DSR
Signal Ground
Data Set Ready
AB
CC
102
107
7
8
RTS
CTS
Request To Send
Clear To Send
CA
CB
105
106
2-16
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.13
Printer and PC Connection
Connection Chart for a Printer / Personal Computer with the System
If you connect a printer or a PC with a 9-pin cable, follow the chart below.
System
9-pin Cable Printer/PC
Circuit
type
Circuit
type
Signal
name
Pin
no.
Pin
no.
Signal
name
(EIA)
(EIA)
BB
RXD
2
2
RXD
BB
BA
CD
TXD
DTR
3
4
3
4
TXD
DTR
BA
CD
AB
CC
SG
5
6
5
6
SG
AB
CC
DSR
DSR
7
8
CA
CB
CA
CB
RTS
CTS
7
8
RTS
CTS
If you connect a printer or a PC with a 25-pin cable, follow the chart below.
System
25-pin Cable Printer/PC
Circuit
Circuit
type
Signal
name
Pin
no.
Pin
no.
Signal
name
type
(EIA)
AA
(EIA)
1
3
FG
BB
RXD
2
RXD
BB
BA
CD
TXD
DTR
3
4
2
TXD
BA
AB
CC
SG
5
6
20
7
DTR
SG
CD
AB
CB
CC
CF
DSR
5
6
8
CTS
DSR
DCD
7
8
CA
CB
RTS
CTS
Installation
2-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.13
Printer and PC Connection
Serial Interface (RS-232C) Signals
Frame Ground: FG
Connects the unit frame and the earth ground conductor of the AC power cord.
Transmitted Data: SD (TXD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (output)
Conveys signals from the unit to the printer. A “Mark” condition is held unless data or
BREAK signals are being transmitted.
Received Data: RD (RXD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (input)
Conveys signals from the printer.
Request to Send: RS (RTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (output)
This lead remains ON whenever DR (DSR) is ON.
Clear To Send: CS (CTS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (input)
When the CS (CTS) circuit is ON, it indicates that the printer is ready to receive data from
the unit. The unit does not attempt to transfer data or receive data when the CS (CTS) circuit
is OFF.
Data Set Ready: DR (DSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (input)
When the DR (DSR) circuit is ON, it indicates the printer is ready. The DR (DSR) circuit
being ON does not indicate that communication has been established with the printer.
Signal Ground: SG
Connects the DC ground of the unit for all interface signals.
Data Terminal Ready: ER (DTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (output)
This signal line is turned ON by the unit to indicate that it is ON
LINE. The ER (DTR) circuit being ON does not indicate that communication has been
established with the printer. It is switched OFF when the unit is OFF LINE.
Data Carrier Detect: CD (DCD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (input)
When ON, it indicates the data terminal (DTE) that the carrier signal is being received.
• Required System Programming
Section 4.2, System Programming
☞
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters
[801] SMDR Parameter
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
2-18
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.14
Location of Optional Cards
The location of the optional cards is shown below.
Precaution
To protect the printed circuit boards (P-boards) from static electricity, do not
touch parts on the P-boards in the main unit and on the optional cards. If
accessing the parts is required, wear a grounding strap.
3 CO Line and 8 EXT
Expansion Card
(KX-TA62477) or
8 Extension Expansion
Card (KX-TA62470)
Doorphone/Door Opener Card
(KX-TA62460) Connector
Connector
The front covers are open.
OGM/FAX Detection Card (KX-TA62491)
Connector
Caller ID Card (KX-TA62493)
Connector
NOTE:
Power off the system, and unplug the AC cord before installing an
optional card.
2.15
OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation
An optional OGM/FAX Detection Card (KX-TA62491) can be installed to the system.
The OGM/FAX Detection Card supports the following.
Direct Inward System Access (DISA) with OGM:
One of the system features. An outgoing message greets the external caller and gives
information so that the caller can access an extension(s) directly.
Facsimile detection:
When the system receives a facsimile transmission signal by DISA, it automatically
connects the specified facsimile extension.
1. Remove the 2 screws.
Screws
Installation
2-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.15
OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation
2. Open the bottom front cover.
Bottom front cover
3. Attach the OGM/FAX Detection card.
OGM/FAX Detection Card
(KX-TA62491)
Note
Please do not damage this part.
4. Insert the flat cables to the card connector.
Flat cables
5. Close the cover.
• Required System Programming
☞
See ‘Required System Programming’ in Section 3, Features “Direct Inward System
Access (DISA)”
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
Outgoing Message (OGM)
2-20
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.16
Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
Four doorphones (KX-T30865) and 4 door openers (user-supplied) can be installed.
Maximum cable length
The maximum length of the doorphone and door opener line cord which connects the system
is as follows.
ø 0.6 mm (24 AWG); Under 113 m
ø 0.8 mm (22 AWG); Under 180 m
(Extension Loop Limit: 20 Ω)
Panasonic
Doorphone
(KX-T30865)
Door Opener
ø 0.8 mm (22 AWG); Under 180 m
Installing the Doorphone
1. Loosen the screw to open the doorphone unit.
Panasonic
Screw
2. Attach the base cover to a wall using 2 screws.
Screws
Note Two kinds of screws are included. Please choose the
appropriate one depending on your type of wall.
Type 1: When a doorphone plate has
been fixed to the wall.
Type 2: When you wish to install the
doorphone directly to the wall.
Installation
2-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.16
Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
3. Connect the wires to the screws located in the front cover.
To the terminal box
4. Put the doorphone together and re-install the screw.
Doorphone/Door Opener Installation
Attach the optional Doorphone/Door Opener Card to the main unit, connect the cord to the
Doorphone/Door Opener Card Connector and secure the screw.
Doorphone Connectors
Door Opener Terminal
Screw
Doorphone/Door Opener Card
(KX-TA62460)
Doorphone/Door Opener Card
Card Connector
2-22
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.16
Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
Wiring of the Doorphone
1. Connect the Doorphone/Door Opener Card to the terminal boxes using 4-conductor
modular connectors.
2. Connect the wires of doorphones 1 and 3 to the red and green screws on the terminal box.
3. Connect the wires of doorphones 2 and 4 to the yellow and black screws on the terminal
box.
View of Doorphone Connector Port
Doorphone 2
Doorphone 1
Doorphone 4
Doorphone 3
4-conductor wiring
is required.
Black
Green
Yellow
Red
Panasonic
Panasonic
Doorphone 1
(KX-T30865)
Doorphone 2
(KX-T30865)
4-conductor wiring
is required.
Black
Green
Yellow
Red
Panasonic
Panasonic
Doorphone 3
(KX-T30865)
Doorphone 4
(KX-T30865)
Installation
2-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.16
Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
Connecting Door Openers
1. While pressing the button below a hole with a screw driver, insert the wire from the door
opener into the hole.
Door opener 1
Door opener 2
Door opener 3
Door opener 4
To the door openers
2. Wrap the strap around all of the cords. (☞ 2.20, Securing the Cords)
• We recommend using the wire (ø 0.4 mm – ø 1.2 mm) or the equivalent for wiring.
• The wire should be under 3.0 mm in diameter including the coating.
• Door Opener ports are at SELV.
!
D = 0.4 mm – 1.2 mm
D = Under 3.0 mm
• Required System Programming
☞
Section 4 System Programming
[700]–[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[703]–[705] Door Opener Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Door Opener, Doorphone Call
2-24
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.17
Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474)
3-CO Line and 8 Ext Expansion Card Installation (KX-TA62477)
To add 3 exchange lines (exchange lines 4 through 6) and 8 extensions (extension ports
09 through 16), use an optional 3-CO Line and 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477).
8 SLT Extension Expansion Card Installation (KX-TA62474)
To add 8 extensions (extension ports 17 through 24), use an optional 8 SLT Extension
Expansion Card (KX-TA62474).
This card can be installed directly to the system or to the KX-TA62477.
• Only a single line telephone (SLT) can be connected to extension ports 17 through 24.
!
Installing the KX-TA62477
1. Loosen the screws and open the top and bottom front covers.
2. Remove the lower front panel with a suitable tool as shown below. Cut the 6 areas
marked with a circle.
Lower front panel
Installation
2-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.17
Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474)
3. After cutting the areas, be sure to cut off any excess plastic in order to make the surface
smooth.
4. First, insert the plastic spacer into the hole on the KX-TA62477. Attach the 2 extension
connectors to the system, install the KX-TA62477 and secure the 2 extension spacers.
Extension Spacers
3 CO Line and 8 EXT Expansion Card
(KX-TA62477)
Caller ID Card Connector
Spacer
Extension Connectors
2-26
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.17
Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474)
5. Insert the modular plugs of the telephone line cords (2-conductor wiring) into the ports
(CO 4 through 6) on the card. (☞ 2.7, Exchange Line Connection)
6. Connect the line cords to the terminal board or the ports from the Local Exchange.
7. Insert the modular plugs of the telephone line cords (2 or 4-conductor wiring) into the
ports (JACK 09 through 16). (☞ 2.8, Extension Connection)
8. Wrap the strap around all of the cords. (☞ 2.19, Securing the Cords)
9. Close the covers and secure the screws.
Installing the KX-TA62474
1. Loosen the screws and open the front and bottom front covers.
2. Remove the lower front panel in the same way as installing a KX-TA62477. If you
install the KX-TA62474 to a KX-TA62477, remove the top front panel with pliers.
Top front panel
3. After cutting the areas, be sure to cut off any excess plastic in order to make the surface
smooth. Please refer to installing the KX-TA62477.
Installation
2-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.17
Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474)
4. Attach the 2 extension connectors to the system first, install the KX-TA62474 and secure
the 2 screws.
Screws
8 SLT Extension Expansion Card
(KX-TA62474)
Extension Connectors
5. Insert the modular plugs of the telephone line cords (2-conductor wiring) into the ports
(JACK 17 through 24). (☞ 2.8, Extension Connection)
6. Wrap the strap around all of the cords. (☞ 2.19, Securing the Cords)
7. Close the covers and secure the screws.
2-28
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.17
Installing a 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion Card (KX-TA62477)
and 8 SLT Extn. Expansion Card (KX-TA62474)
Installing the KX-TA62477 and KX-TA62474
1. Install the KX-TA62477 first and then the KX-TA62474.
Screws
8 SLT Extension Expansion Card
(KX-TA62474)
Extension Spacers
Extension Connectors
3 CO Line and 8 EXT Expansion Card
(KX-TA62477)
Spacer
Extension Connectors
Installation
2-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.18
Auxiliary Connection for Power Failure Transfer
Power failure transfer connects a specific single line telephone (SLT) to selected exchange
lines in the event of system power failure, as follows.
Exchange line 1 – extension (T, R) port 01
Exchange line 4 – extension (T, R) port 09
Connection of exchange lines 1 and 4, and the respective extensions require no auxiliary
connection.
• In the event of a power failure, system memory is protected by a factory-provided lithium
battery. There is no memory loss except the Camp-on, Saved Number Redial, Last Number
Redial, Call Park and Message Waiting memories.
• The system automatically changes the current connection to the above connection when the
power supply stops.
!
• Proprietary telephones cannot be used during a power failure. Therefore, we recommend
connecting SLTs in parallel with proprietary telephones connected to extension ports
01 and 09.
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Power Failure Transfer, Parallelled Telephone Connection
2-30
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.19
Securing the Cords
1. Wrap the strap around all of the cords.
• To remove the rivet, use a screw driver as shown below.
!
Rivet
2.20
Closing the Front Cover
1. Replace the covers and tighten the screws.
2. Tie together all of the connected cords and attach them to the wall so that the cords
cannot be pulled out of the system.
Installation
2-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.21
Starting the System for the First Time
1. Set the Power Switch to the “OFF” position.
2. Plug the AC power cord into the system and an AC outlet.
3. Turn the Power Switch on.
(The power indicator will light.)
4. Perform the following operation with a proprietary telephone connected to JACK 01.
a) Set the MEMORY switch to “PROGRAM” on the back of the telephone.
b) Press
#.
c) Enter 1234.
d) Enter 999.
e) Press the NEXT (SP-PHONE) button.
f) Press the SELECT (AUTO ANSWER/MUTE) button until
“All Para” is displayed.
g) Press the STORE (AUTO DIAL/STORE) button.
h) Press the END (HOLD) button.
i) Set the MEMORY switch to “SET” on the back of the telephone.
The system will be initialised with the default values. If the system does not work properly,
please see 2.23, “System Data Clear”.
CAUTION • The system will continue to be powered even if the Power Switch is turned
“OFF”.
• The power supply cord is used as the main disconnect device. Ensure that the
outlet is located/installed near the equipment and is easily accessible.
To AC outlet
2-32
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.22
System Restart
After starting the system, if the system does not operate properly, restart the system.
Before restarting the system, try the system feature again to confirm whether there definitely
is a problem or not.
System Restart causes the following.
• Camp-on is cleared.
• Calls on Hold are terminated.
• Calls on Exclusive Hold are terminated.
• Calls in progress are terminated.
• Call Park is cleared.
• Message Waiting is cleared.
• Last Number Redial is cleared.
• Saved Number Redial is cleared.
Other data is not cleared by System Restart.
1. Turn the Power Switch “OFF” and then “ON”.
• If the system still does not operate properly, please see 2.23, “System Data Clear”.
!
Installation
2-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.23
System Data Clear
When the system does not operate properly after restarting, you can clear the programming
data stored in the system. The system will restart with the default settings.
First, try system program [999] “System Data Clear” by following step 4 in 2.21, “Starting
the System for the First Time”. If the system still does not operate properly, please follow
the procedure below.
1. Slide the System Clear Switch to the “CLEAR” position.
2. Press the Reset Button.
3. Return the System Clear Switch to the “NORMAL” position before the power indicator
stops flashing.
(The power indicator will flash for about 10 seconds.)
Reset Button
System Clear Switch
CAUTION • Before touching the System Clear Switch and Reset Button, put on a
grounding strap.
• After pressing the Reset Button, return the System Clear Switch to the “NORMAL”
position in step 3 before the power indicator stops flashing. Otherwise, the system will
not clear.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
System Data Default Set
2-34
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 3
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Absent Message Capability
Allows an extension user to set a message which will be displayed at the calling extension
to show the reason for the called extension’s absence. One of 6 messages can be
programmed as desired, which are available for any telephone (single line telephone or
proprietary telephone). Setting or cancelling a message can be done by individual extension
users but only callers using a proprietary telephone with a LCD can see the message.
• The 6 messages are shown below. “%” means a parameter to be entered when assigning
a message at an extension.
!
(1) Will Return Soon
(2) Gone Home
(3) At Ext %%% (extension number)
(4) Back at %% : %% AM (or PM) (hour : minute)
(5) Out Until %%/%% (day / month)
(6) In a Meeting
• An extension user can only select one message at a time. The selected message is
displayed every time the user goes off-hook.
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.6 Before Leaving Your Desk, “Showing Your Message on the Calling Party’s Display
(Absent Message Capability)”
3-2
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Account Code Entry
An account code is used to identify incoming and outgoing outside calls for accounting and
billing purposes. The account code is appended to the SMDR call record. For incoming
outside calls, an account code is optional. For outgoing outside calls, there are 4 account
input modes programmable in program [605], Option, Forced, Verify–All and Verify–Toll.
Option:
A 4-digit code may be entered during a conversation or within 30 seconds
after a conversation when a record is needed.
Forced:
A 4-digit code must be entered within 5 seconds after an exchange line is
seized. The code can be any number.
Verify–All: Enables to make an outside call if the code entered within 5 seconds after an
extension user seizes an exchange line is the same as one of the account
codes programmed in [310].
Verify–Toll: Enables to override call barring temporarily by entering one of the account
codes programmed in [310] within 5 seconds after an exchange line is
seized. Calls with COS numbers 3 through 5 will be treated as calls with
COS number 2. Calls with COS numbers 1 and 2 will not be affected.
• Required System Programming
☞
[310] Account Codes
[601]-[603] Call Barring – Class of Service Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch
[605] Account Code Entry Mode
[805] SMDR Account Code Selection
• Related Feature References
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR),
Call Barring Override by Account Codes
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Calling with Account Codes (Account Code Entry)”
Alternate Calling – Ring/Voice
This system offers a proprietary telephone user 2 types of intercom calling, Voice Call mode
and Tone (ring) Call mode. “Voice Call” informs the called party of an incoming call with
the calling party’s voice, while “Tone Call” uses a ring tone. A proprietary telephone user
can select “Voice Call” or “Tone Call” in the Proprietary Telephone Settings. If the user
selects “Voice Call”, the calling party can talk to the user immediately after the confirmation
tone. The calling party can switch the pre-set mode at the called extension, from “Voice
Call” to “Tone Call” or vice versa, by pressing “ ” after dialling the extension number.
• A rotary telephone user cannot change the pre-set mode at the called extension.
!
☞
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”, Intercom
Alert Assignment
1.7 Useful Features, “Alternate Calling – Ring/Voice”
Features
3-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-On)
When the selected exchange line or dialled extension is busy, the system will automatically
notify an extension user with a callback ringing when the line becomes available. When the
user answers the callback ringing:
For an extension:
The called extension starts ringing without dialling.
For an exchange line: The line is seized.
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.3 Making Calls, “Making Your Telephone Ring Back Automatically When a Line
Becomes Free (Automatic Callback Busy – Camp-On)”
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number
An Automatic Line Access number (0 or 9) can be programmed. When an extension user
dials an Automatic Line Access number before a telephone number, an available exchange
line from the assigned lines in program [419] is seized automatically. If “0” is selected in
program [121], the operator call will be “9” automatically. If “9” is selected in program
[121], the operator call will be “0” automatically.
• Related Feature References
☞
Operator Call, Outside Calling
• Required System Programming
[121] Automatic Exchange Line Access Number Selection
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access
3-4
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
The system automatically selects the least expensive route available at the time a long
distance call is made on the exchange line enabled for ARS feature. It is not necessary to dial
the access code of the least expensive carrier.
1. Normal Use
To make a call via the least expensive carrier, the dialled number is modified. The following
are modification examples.
Example 1 (Long distance call using Route 1):
[350] “ARS Selection”: Enable
[351] “Route 1 Selection Codes (Leading Digit)”: 0
[355] “Route 1 Exception Codes”: 07
[360] “ARS Modification – Removed Digits”: 0 (No deletion)
[361] “ARS Modification – Added Number”: 131(Code of least expensive carrier for a
long distance call)
[381] “Route 1 Authorisation Code”: 0123456789
[385] “Route 1 Itemised Bill”: Enable
[389] “Itemised Bill Code Assignment”: 201
<Dialled number>
01633 877 467
<Modified number>
131 0123456789 201 01633 877 467
Example 2 (International call using Route 2):
[350] “ARS Selection”: Enable
[352] “Route 2 Selection Codes (Leading Digit)”: 00
[360] “ARS Modification – Removed Digits”: 0
[361] “ARS Modification – Added Number”: 1620 (Code of least expensive carrier for
an international call)
[386] “Route 2 Itemised Bill”: Enable
[389] “Itemised Bill Code Assignment”: 201
<Dialled number>
00 44 1344 853941
<Modified number>
1620 201 00 44 1344 853941
Example 3 (Long distance call via the first carrier):
[350] “ARS Selection”: Enable
[359] “1st Carrier Selection Code”: 121
<Dialled number>
121 01633 877 467
<Modified number>
01633 877 467
Features
3-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
2. Special Use
If an extension user always uses the Automatic Line Access number (9 or 0) when making
an outside call and wants to seize the specified trunk group as below automatically, refer to
the following program assignment.
<Example>
• Trunk group which connects with the least expensive carrier for a long distance call
(Long distance calls start with “0”. Carrier code = 131)
• Trunk group which connects with the least expensive carrier for an international call
(International calls start with “00”. Carrier code = 1620)
• Trunk group connected to a mobile telephone
(No modification of the dialled number is necessary.)
To specify how to modify the dialled number, and specify a trunk group for each
route
Program
Address
[351]
[354]
[355]
[358]
07
[360]
[361]
[364]
Route
No.
Route 1
0
0 digit
0 digits
0 digit
131
trunk group number 1
trunk group number 1
trunk group number 2
Route 2
Route 3
00
1620
079
To specify exchange lines in the trunk groups
Program
Address
[419] Automatic
Designated
Exchange Line
Access
[404] Trunk Group
[350]
Assignment
Exchange
Line No.
1
2
3
trunk group number 1
trunk group number 1
trunk group number 2
Enable
Enable
Enable
Enable
Enable
Disable
First
Carrier
Local Call
Second
Carrier
131 (Long Distance Call)
Mobile
Jack
KX-TA624
Third
Carrier
1620 (International Call)
Exchange Line
1
2
3
Group1
Group2
3-6
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Example 5 [Long distance call using Route 1 (trunk group number 1)]:
<Dialled number>
9 01633 877 467
<Modified number>
131 01633 877 467
Example 6 [International call using Route 2 (trunk group number 1)]:
<Dialled number>
<Modified number>
9 00 44 1344 853941
1620 201 00 44 1344 853941
Example 7 [Mobile telephone call using Route 3 (trunk group number 2)]:
<Dialled number>
9 07979 123456
<Modified number>
07979 123456
• System Programming is required to execute this feature.
• If an extension user makes an outside call using the Automatic Line Access number (9 or 0)
and the dialled number does not apply to any numbers assigned in programs [351]–[354],
an exchange line which has selected “Enable” in program [419] “Automatic Designated
Exchange Line Access” is automatically seized.
• Required System Programming
☞
[350] ARS Selection
[351]-[354] Routes 1 through 4 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
[355]-[358] Routes 1 through 4 Exception Codes
[359] 1st Carrier Selection Code (BT Line Access Code)
[360] ARS Modification – Removed Digits
[361] ARS Modification – Added Number
[362] ARS Dial Tone Pattern Selection
[363] ARS Interdigit Time
[364] ARS Trunk Group
[381]-[384] Routes 1 through 4 Authorisation Codes
[385]-[388] Routes 1 through 4 Itemised Bill
[389] Itemised Bill Code Assignment
Features
3-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
Flow chart of possible cases and results for ARS calls
Start
A
*1
Is (another) 1 digit dialled within
the ARS Interdigit Time?
No
Yes
*2
Yes
Each time a digit is dialled, the system checks the
dialled number (other than Host PBX access codes,
Is the dialled number a
call barring denied code?
Reorder tone
Carrier excepted codes and 1st carrier access code).
No
*3
Yes
The dialled number is sent
to the Local Exchange.
Is the dialled number an
emergency call number?
No
*4
Yes
Is the dialled number a
call barring denied code?
Reorder tone
No
Yes
The dialled number (other than the 1st carrier
access code) is sent to the Local Exchange.
Does the dialled number include
the 1st carrier access code?
No
*6
*7
*8
*5
Does the area code match a
Route 1 selection code?
Does the area code
match a Route 1
exception code?
Removing from
and adding to the
dialled number.
Yes
No
No
No
No
Route 1 is
selected.
No
Yes
*10
*7
*7
*8
Route 2 is
selected.
*9
Does the area code match a
Route 2 selection code?
Does the area code
match a Route 2
exception code?
Removing from
and adding to the
dialled number.
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
*12
*8
Route 3 is
selected.
*11
Does the area code match a
Route 3 selection code?
Does the area code
match a Route 3
exception code?
Removing from
and adding to the
dialled number.
No
Yes
*14
*7
*8
*13
Does the area code match a
Route 4 selection code?
Does the area code
match a Route 4
exception code?
Removing from
and adding to the
dialled number.
Route 4 is
selected.
No
Yes
Are 7 digits (other than Host PBX
access codes, Carrier excepted codes
and 1st carrier access code) dialled?
No
Yes
*15
The dialled number is sent
to the Local Exchange.
Goes to
A
3-8
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
A
*1: The ARS Interdigit timer is assigned in program [363] “ARS Interdigit Time”.
*2: The codes are assigned in the following programs.
Host PBX access codes: [403] “Host PBX Access Codes”
Carrier excepted codes: [300] “Carrier Excepted Code Assignment”
1st carrier access code: [359] “1st Carrier Selection Code”.
*3: Emergency call numbers are assigned in program [309] “Emergency Dial Number Set”.
*4: Call Barring denied codes are assigned in program [302]-[305] “Call Barring – Classes 2
through 5 Denied Codes”.
*5: Route 1 selection codes are assigned in program [351] “Route 1 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)”.
*6: Route 1 exception codes are assigned in program [355] “Route 1 Exception Codes”.
*7: Removing digits are assigned in program [360] “ARS Modification – Removed Digits” and
added numbers are in [361] “ARS Modification – Added Number”
*8: The trunk group(s) assigned in program [364] is (are) automatically seized when making a call
using the Automatic Exchange Line Access number (0 or 9).
*9: Route 2 selection codes are assigned in program [352] “Route 2 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)”.
*10: Route 2 exception codes are assigned in program [356] “Route 2 Exception Codes”.
*11: Route 3 selection codes are assigned in program [353] “Route 3 Selection Codes (Leading
Digits)”.
*12: Route 3 exception codes are assigned in program [357] “Route 3 Exception Codes”.
*13: Route 4 selection codes are assigned in program [354] “Route 4 Selection Codes (Leading
Digits)”.
*14: Route 4 exception codes are assigned in program [358] “Route 4 Exception Codes”.
*15: The system repeats checking until 7 digits are dialled.
Features
3-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
B
Busy Extension Signalling
When an extension user calls a busy extension, the busy extension will hear a Call Waiting
tone to know that a call is waiting.
• This feature is only available if the called extension has set the Call Waiting feature. If
the Call Waiting feature is activated, the caller will hear a ringback tone. If not, the caller
will hear a reorder tone.
!
• Related Feature Reference
☞
Call Waiting
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.3 Making Calls, “Sending a Call Waiting Tone to a Busy Extension (Busy Extension
Signalling)”
She is on the line.
I will send a Call
Waiting tone.
CALL WAITING TONE
I’ve got another call.
Please hold.
3-10
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Barring
Call Barring is a system programmable feature that can prohibit certain extension users from
making unauthorised toll calls.
Every extension is programmed to belong to one of 5 classes of service (COS). Each COS is
programmed to have a call barring class for day mode, night mode and lunch mode.
There are 5 call barring COS numbers available. Call barring COS number 1 is the highest
class and the COS number 5 is the lowest. That is, COS number 1 allows all toll calls. COS
numbers 2 through 5 are used to restrict calls by combining pre-programmed deny and
exception codes shown in the table on the next page.
Denied Codes
An outgoing outside call made by an extension with a call barring COS number between 2
and 5 is first checked against the assigned denied codes in program [302]-[305].
If the first digits of the dialled number (not including the line access code) are not found in
the class, the call can be made. Each class can store up to 20 denied codes, each consisting
of 11 digits.
Exception Codes
These codes are used to override a programmed denied code. A call denied by the denied
codes is checked against the selected exception codes assigned in program [306]. If a match
is found, the call can be made.
Up to 80 exception codes, each consisting of 11 digits, can be stored. The available number
of codes depends on the COS number.
• Emergency numbers, such as the police or fire station, should be stored in program
[309] “Emergency Dial Number Set” so that they are exempt from call barring.
• If a stored Host PBX access code in program [403] “Host PBX Access Codes” or a stored
carrier code in program [300] “Carrier Excepted Code Assignment” is found in the
dialled number, the subsequent telephone numbers will be checked for call barring.
• The interdigit timer assigned in program [208] “Interdigit Time” applies until the call
barring check is completed. When the timer expires, an outside outgoing call will be
disconnected while dialling, if “Enable” was selected in program [211] “No Dial
Disconnection”.
!
• The call barring class for a locked extension can be assigned in program [312] “Call
Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class” so that even a locked extension can make a
local call, etc.
• It is programmable whether the “ ” or “#” the user dials is to be checked or not on the
Call Barring code in program [125] “Call Barring Check for and #”. This is useful to
prevent unauthorised calls which could be possible through certain Local Exchange
systems.
• Required System Programming
☞
[301] Call Barring – System Speed Dialling Boundary Class
[302]-[305] Call Barring – Classes 2 through 5 Denied Codes
[306] Call Barring – Exception Codes
[601]-[603] Call Barring – Class of Service Assignment – Day/Night/Lunch
• Related Feature References
Emergency Call
Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class
Call Barring for System Speed Dialling
Call Barring Override by Account Codes
Features
3-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Combination of denied codes and exception codes
COS No.
Denied Calls
No restriction.
20 denied codes programmed in [302].
Excepted Calls
No restriction.
80 exception codes (code numbers 01-80)
programmed in [306].
1
2
3
4
20 denied codes programmed in [302] plus 60 exception codes (code numbers 01-60)
20 denied codes programmed in [303]. programmed in [306].
20 denied codes programmed in [302] plus 40 exception codes (code numbers 01-40)
20 denied codes programmed in [303] plus programmed in [306].
20 denied codes programmed in [304].
5
20 denied codes programmed in [302] plus 20 exception codes (code numbers 01-20)
20 denied codes programmed in [303] plus programmed in [306].
20 denied codes programmed in [304] plus
20 denied codes programmed in [305].
Flow chart of Call Barring
The user makes a toll call.
*1
Is it a System Speed Dialling number?
Yes
No
*2
Yes
Is the COS number higher than the
system speed dialling boundary class?
No or Equal
COS1
What is the
COS number?
COS2 - 5
Is the dialled number found
in applicable denied codes?
No
Yes
*1: System Speed Dialling
numbers are assigned in
program [001] “System
Speed Dialling Entry”.
*2: The system speed dialling
boundary class is assigned in
program [301] “Call Barring
– System Speed Dialling
Boundary Class”.
Is the dialled number found in
applicable exception codes?
Yes
No
The call is allowed.
The call is denied. A reorder
tone is returned to the user.
3-12
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Barring — Extension Lock Boundary Class
Allows assigning a call barring class for extensions where the Electronic Extension Lockout
or Remote Extension Lock feature has been set.
An extension user usually cannot make an outside call at a locked extension, however if a
call barring class is assigned in program [312], the user can make an outside call at the
locked extension.
• The higher call barring class number will take precedence.
For example, if call barring COS number 3 is assigned to an extension and the extension
lock boundary class is 4, the extension user is allowed to make a call with call barring
COS number 4.
!
• Required System Program Address
☞
[312] Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class
• Related Feature References
Extension Lock, Call Barring
Call Barring for System Speed Dialling
Calls originated by System Speed Dialling are restricted depending on the combination of
the System Speed Dialling Boundary Class assigned in program [301] and the class of
service (COS) assigned to each extension as follows.
System Speed
Boundary
Dialling
Class
COS
No.
<Example>
—If the boundary is set to
COS number 2,
1
A
C
C
C
C
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
A
A
C
C
C
A
A
A
C
C
A
A
A
A
C
A
A
A
A
A
The system will allow system
speed dialling for COS numbers 1
and 2, but check COS numbers 3,
4 and 5 according to call barring.
A: allowed
C: checked
• Required System Programming
☞
[301] Call Barring – System Speed Dialling Boundary Class
• Related Feature Reference
Call Barring
Features
3-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Barring Override by Account Codes
Allows an extension user to override call barring temporarily to make a toll call from a
toll-restricted extension. The user can carry out this feature by entering one of the account
codes programmed in [310] “Account Codes” before dialling the telephone number. The
user can make a toll call with the COS number 2.
• The account code “Verify-toll (call barring)” mode at an extension permits users to
override their call barrings.
• This feature can be used on extensions assigned to call barring COS numbers 3 through
5. The COS numbers 1 and 2 will not be changed.
!
• If the user does not enter an account code or enters an invalid one, a regular call barring
check is done.
• When a user makes a call using this feature, it will appear on the SMDR printout with
either the entered 4-digit account code or the 2-digit index of the entered account code.
This selection is set in program [805].
• Users can also override call barring of another extension by using the Walking COS
feature.
Flow chart of Call Barring Override
Call Barring Override by Account Codes is attempted.
Verify–All
Option/Forced
What is the account code mode?
Verify–Toll
Does the entered code match
a stored account code?
Does the entered code match
a stored account code?
No
Yes
Is the COS number 1?
No
Yes
Yes
No
The call is made with the
COS number 2.
The call is not allowed.
A reorder tone is
returned to the user.
The Call Barring COS
number remains the same as
the extension being used.
• Required System Programming
[310] Account Codes
☞
[605] Account Code Entry Mode
[805] SMDR Account Codes Selection
• Related Feature References
Account Code Entry, Call Barring, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR),
Walking COS
3-14
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Forwarding
Allows an extension user to transfer incoming calls automatically to another extension or to
an external destination. The following types are available.
All Calls:
All incoming calls are forwarded to another extension.
Busy or No Answer: All incoming calls are forwarded to another extension when the
extension user does not answer within the programmed time in
[202] or when the extension is busy.
To an Exchange Line: Allows an extension user enabled in program [607] to forward all
incoming intercom calls to an external party.
Follow Me:
Allows an extension user to set the Call Forwarding – All Calls
feature from another extension.
• Extensions which have already been assigned as
a forwarded destination cannot set the Call
Forwarding feature.
!
• If the Do Not Disturb (DND) feature has
already been set, setting the Call Forwarding
feature will cancel DND.
• When using the call forward to an exchange line feature the quality of service may be
adversely affected by the attenuation across the public telephone network.
• Required System Programming
[202] Call Forwarding Start Time
☞
[607] Call Forwarding to an Exchange Line
• Related Feature Reference
Limited Call Duration
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
FWD/DND (Forward/Do Not Disturb) Button
1.6 Before Leaving Your Desk, “Forwarding a Call (Call Forwarding)”
Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection
The Calling Party Control (CPC) signal is a disconnect signal sent from the Local Exchange
for an outside call. The CPC signal detection is activated by programs [420] and [421].
Program [420] is for incoming outside calls, and [421] is for outgoing outside calls.
• Required System Programming
☞
[420] Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal
[421] CPC Detection for Outgoing Calls
Features
3-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Park
Allows an extension user to place a held call into a system parking area. Any extension user
can retrieve the parked call to perform other operations. Up to 10 calls can be parked at the
same time.
• If a parked call is not retrieved within the assigned time in program [200], a ring tone or
an alarm tone will be heard.
• If a parked call is not retrieved within 30 minutes, it will be automatically disconnected.
• This feature is useful when an extension user wants to hold more than one intercom call
with a proprietary telephone, or more than one intercom call or outside call with a single
line telephone.
!
• During a 5-party conference, this feature cannot be performed.
• Required System Programming
Parking zone
☞
[200] Hold Recall Time
• Related Feature Reference
Conference (5-party)
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.5 During Conversation, “Placing
a Call in System Parking Area
(Call Park)”
3-16
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Pickup
<Directed Call Pickup>
Allows an extension user to answer a call ringing at any other extension.
<Group Call Pickup>
Allows an extension user to answer a call ringing at another extension, if the call is ringing
within the user’s extension group assigned in program [600]. If “Enable” is selected for an
extension group in [127], persons in the group can pickup calls just by going off-hook, even
though their extension is not ringing.
<Call Pickup Deny>
Allows an extension user to prevent other extensions from picking up a call ringing at the
user’s extension with the Call Pickup feature.
<Call Retrieving from a TAM (Telephone Answering Machine)>
Allows an extension user to answer an incoming call received by a TAM extension assigned
in program [611].
• The user can pick up an incoming outside, intercom or doorphone call with the Directed
Call Pickup or Group Call Pickup feature.
• A confirmation tone is sent to the user when the call is picked up with the Directed Call
Pickup or Group Call Pickup feature. The tone can be disabled in program [117].
• If a ringing extension sets the Call Pickup Deny feature, an extension user will hear a
reorder tone when the user tries to pick up the call.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[117] Call Pickup Tone
[127] Pickup Group Set
[600] Extension Group Assignment
[611] TAM (Telephone Answering Machine)
Extension
He’s not in.
I’ll answer it.
Hello.
Sorry, Mr. Smith is
out of the office.
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.4 Receiving Calls, “Picking up a Call
Ringing at Another Extension
(Call Pickup)”
Call Splitting
Allows an extension user to talk to 2 different parties. If a call is received while the user is
already on the line, the user can place the current call on hold and have a conversation with
the other party.
• This feature is not possible for a doorphone call, page or 5-party conference.
!
• Related Feature References
☞
Conference (5-party), Doorphone Call, Paging
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.5 During Conversation, “Call Splitting”
Features
3-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Transfer – to Exchange Line
Allows an extension user enabled in program [606] to transfer a received intercom call to an
external party.
• A single line telephone user cannot transfer a received call to an external party.
• To join the conversation again after transferring the call, press the corresponding line key.
A conference call will be established. This feature is not available for a single line
telephone.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[606] Call Transfer to an Exchange Line
• Related Feature Reference
Hold, Limited Call Duration
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.5 During Conversation, “Transferring a Call to an Exchange Line (Call Transfer – to
Exchange Line)”
Call Transfer – to Extension
Allows an extension user to transfer a received call, an intercom or an outside call, to
another extension. Two types are available.
Screened Call Transfer: Announces the call to another extension before completing
the transfer.
Unscreened Call Transfer:Immediately releases the call to another extension without an
announcement.
• If the destination extension does not answer the call within the assigned time in program
[201], the call will return to the transferring party.
• An outside call can be transferred to an extension by simply pressing a DSS button. It
requires program [005].
!
• If Music on Hold is enabled, music is sent to the original external caller while being
transferred. Sending a cyclic tone or music on hold can be programmed by program
[111].
• During a 5-party conference, the user cannot transfer a call.
• Required System Programming
[005] One-Touch Transfer Using a DSS Button
[111] Hold Music Selection
☞
[201] Transfer Recall Time
• Related Feature References
Conference (5-party), Hold, Music on Hold
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.5 During Conversation, “Transferring a Call to an Extension (Call Transfer – to
Extension)”
3-18
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Call Waiting
During a conversation, a Call Waiting tone informs an extension user that there is a call
waiting. The user can answer the second call by disconnecting the first call or placing it on
hold. When Call Waiting is enabled, a Call Waiting tone is sent to the user under the
following conditions.
1) When an outside call (except a doorphone
call) is received, or
CALL WAITING TONE
I’ve got another call.
Please hold.
2) When another extension executes the Busy
Extension Signalling feature.
• For proprietary telephone users, a Call Waiting tone (Tone 1 or Tone 2) can be selected in
the Proprietary Telephone Settings. Tone 2 depends on System Programming. Program
[423] is for outside calls and program [115] is for intercom calls.
!
15 s
Tone 1
5 s
Tone 2
Single:
Double:
Triple:
• Required System Programming
☞
[115] Extension Ringing Pattern Selection
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection
• Related Feature Reference
Hold
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings,
“Customising Your Telephone Functions”, Call Waiting Tone Selection
1.5 During Conversation, “Call Waiting”
Features
3-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C
Conference (3-party)
During a 2-party conversation, an extension user can add a third party to make a 3-party
conference. The maximum number of members of a conference can be programmed in
program [116].
• The possible combinations, through System Programming, are 3 extensions, 1 extension
and 2 external parties, or 2 extensions and 1 external party.
• When a 2-party call is changed to a 3-party call or vice versa, a confirmation tone is sent
to all 3 parties. The tone can be disabled by program [105].
!
• A 3-party call can also be established by the Executive Busy Override feature.
• Required System Programming
[105] Conference Tone
☞
[116] Conference Pattern Selection
[606] Call Transfer to an Exchange Line
• Related Feature References
Executive Busy Override
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
CONF (Conference) Button
1.7 Useful Features, “Conference (3-party)”
3-20
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
C-D
Conference (5-party)
Allows an extension user to establish a 5-party conference when “5 party C-2 E-5” is
selected in program [116].
• Up to 2 external parties can participate in a conference call.
• All 5 parties can be extensions.
• Only one 5-party conference can be established at one time.
• When a 5-party conference is established, a confirmation tone is sent to all parties. The
tone can be disabled by program [105].
!
• The Executive Busy Override and the Call Park features are not available during a 5-party
conference.
• Required System Programming
[105] Conference Tone
☞
[116] Conference Pattern Selection
• Related Feature References
Conference (3-party), Call Park, Executive Busy Override
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
CONF (Conference) Button
1.7 Useful Features, “Conference (5-party)”
Data Line Security
Prevents an extension user from being interrupted by the Call Waiting and Executive Busy
Override features. This feature also prevents a ring tone or an alarm tone from being sent
when a call is kept waiting longer than a pre-determined time. Data communication devices,
such as computers and facsimiles, connected to an extension port can operate without
interruptions.
• Related Feature References
☞
Call Waiting, Executive Busy Override
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Data Line Security”
Features
3-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
Date and Time Setting
A manager or operator can adjust the current time.
• Required System Programming
☞
[000] Date and Time Setting
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Date and Time Setting”
Direct In Line (DIL)
Enables an incoming outside call to go directly to a specified extension. This exchange line
can be used by multiple extension users to make a call, but can only be used by one
extension to receive a call. DIL can have a different destination in the day, night and/or
lunch modes.
• If the destination extension is in an extension group which has
enabled the Extension Hunting feature in program [100] “Hunting
Group Set”, Extension Hunting (Terminate or Circular in program
[101] “Hunting Type”) works when the extension is busy.
!
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
• Required System Programming
☞
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
1
4
7
2
5
8
0
3
6
9
• Related Feature References
Extension Hunting, Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
Allows an outside caller to access specific system features as if the caller is an extension in
the system. The caller can have direct access to features such as:
• Placing an incoming call to an extension, extension group or operator. The caller also
has the option of dialling the route for an extension using a 1 digit number (DISA built-
in auto attendant number) via DISA calls.
The DISA feature operates without an optional card installed. If an outgoing message
(OGM) which greets a caller and gives information, or fax detection is required, an optional
OGM/FAX Detection Card must be installed. The system can detect a FAX (CNG) tone
according to program [514]. An OGM can be programmed in program [502] (☞ “Outgoing
Message (OGM)” in this section). When a caller reaches a DISA line, a message will greet
the caller. Two different DISA messages can be recorded by the operator or manager. For
example, one message can be used in day mode and the other in night mode, or they can be
used for different exchange lines. If an optional OGM/FAX Detection Card is not installed,
the caller will hear a short beep instead of the OGM (Internal DISA).
3-22
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
• “DISA1” or “DISA 2” must be assigned to exchange line(s) as the exchange line mode in
programs [414] through [416].
• After the DISA Delayed Answer Time assigned in program [504] expires and a ringback
tone is returned to the caller, a DISA call will be answered. The caller can dial during the
message or after the tone.
!
• This system can store up to 10 programmable DISA built-in auto attendant numbers in
program [501]. Each number is 1 digit.
• The DISA built-in auto attendant number may be the same as the first digit of other
numbers (extension number, etc.). To avoid confusion, the system waits for the second
digit for a preprogrammed amount of time in program [517] (default: 2 seconds). If the
timer expires, the system will assume that the first digit is a DISA built-in auto attendant
number.
• Only one OGM/FAX Detection Card can be installed .
• Connection Reference
☞
2.15 OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation
• Required System Programming
To enable the DISA feature
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
[420] Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal
[500] DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection
[501] DISA Built-in Auto Attendant
[502] OGM Mode Selection
[503] FAX Connection
[506] DISA Busy Mode
[510] DISA No Dial Mode
[513] Cyclic Tone Detection
[514] FAX Tone Detection
[516] DISA Incoming Assignment
To set DISA timer values
[504] DISA Delayed Answer Time
[505] DISA Waiting Time after OGM
[517] DISA AA Wait Time
[519] DISA OGM Mute Time
To enable the Intercept Routing feature
[408]–[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[507] DISA Intercept Mode
[508] DISA Ringing Time before Intercept
[509] DISA Ringing Time after Intercept
[515] Intercept Time for Internal DISA
• Related Feature References
Extension Hunting,
Intercept Routing, Outgoing Message (OGM)
Features
3-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
DISA Operation
Calling an extension by following the outgoing message
from an External Party
DISA phone no.
extension no.
Ringback tone and
Enter the extension number.
Ring back tone
Enter the DISA phone number.
DISA outgoing message
• You can dial the AA number* instead.
Calling an extension without an outgoing message (Internal DISA)
from an External Party
DISA phone no.
extension no.
Ringback tone
and
Enter the extension number.
Ring back tone
Enter the DISA phone number.
one short beep
• You can dial the AA number* instead.
AA number*: A DISA built-in auto attendant number assigned in program [501] “DISA Built-in Auto
Attendant”.
3-24
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
Flow chart of possible cases and results for DISA calls
An exchange line call is made.
*1
The caller reaches the DISA line.
With optional
OGM/FAX Detection Card
Without optional
OGM/FAX Detection Card
(Internal DISA)
*2
*11
One short beep
OGM
*12
C
*3
*16
Cyclic tone,
CPC signal
FAX (CNG) tone
*13
*4
A number is dialled.
Nothing is dialled.
The call is sent to
the fax extension.
Disconnect
*14
Is Intercept Routing employed?
Yes
Busy tone
No
The call is sent to
another extension.
The call reaches the destination.
*5
Disconnect.
*15
A
Answered.
*7
The destination
extension(s) is(are) busy.
The call is not answered.
Answered.
B
Answered.
The call is not
answered.
*6
Is Intercept Routing employed?
*8
What is the DISA
Busy Mode?
The call is not
answered for
40 seconds.
Yes
No
Disconnect.
The call is sent to
another extension.
Disconnect
Busy tone
DISA2
Call Waiting
Disconnect.
The other
OGM is heard.
*9
Goes to
A
Disconnect.
*10
Goes to
C
Answered.
The call is not
answered.
Goes to
B
Note: The explanation for *1 through *16 is on the next page.
Features
3-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
*1: The DISA Delayed timer starts. This is the time between a call reaching the system and being
received. The time is assigned in program [504].
*2: When the assigned time period in program [519] expires, the system sends a short beep to the
caller.
*3: The Intercept Timer for Internal DISA starts. This is the time the system waits for the number
sent by the caller. If nothing is entered by the caller during this time, the system will regard it as
“Nothing is dialled.” The time is assigned in program [515].
*4: The system can accept the following numbers:
• 200 through 299 as an extension number.
• 0 or 9 as the operator call number when the operator is assigned in program
[008] “Operator Assignment” and “Without AA” is assigned in program [500]. Even if “With
AA” is assigned, 0 or 9 is regarded as the operator call number if nothing is assigned to “0” or
“9” in program [501].
• 0 through 9 as a built-in auto attendant number when “With AA” is assigned in program [500].
The DISA AA Wait timer starts after receiving the first 1-digit number. If the timer expires, the
system will assume that the first digit is an AA number. The time is assigned in program [517].
*5: The DISA Ring Timer Before Intercept starts. The destination telephone(s) will ring for the time
programmed in [508].
*6: The system treats the call according to program [507] as follows.
• Disconnect – the call is disconnected.
• Intercept – the call is sent to the extensions programmed in [408]-[410] “Flexible Ringing
Assignment – Day/Night/Lunch”.
If the call is still not answered within the time programmed in [509], it will be disconnected.
*7: If the destination extension belongs to a hunting group and all extensions in the group are busy,
the system will check the DISA Busy Mode. If the destination is a DISA ring group, the DISA
Busy Mode will not work for the call. The system regards the call as unanswered.
*8: The DISA Busy Mode is selected in program [506]. There are 3 modes as follows.
• Disconnect – the caller hears a busy tone and a call is disconnected.
• Call Waiting – the destination extension hears a call waiting tone if they have enabled Call
Waiting.
• DISA2 – if “MODE2” is assigned in program [502] and a message is recorded in OGM2, the
caller will hear the message and the system waits for the new destination.
3-26
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
*9: The DISA Ring Timer Before Intercept starts. The destination telephone(s) will ring for the time
programmed in [508].
*10: In this case, the system does not accept a line access code. If nothing is recorded in OGM2 or
OGM2 is used for another caller, the caller will hear a busy tone and the call is disconnected.
*11: The OGM is sent to the caller according to programs [414]–[416] and [502] when the assigned
time in program [519] expires. If an OGM is not recorded, the DISA Wait Timer After OGM
programmed in [505] starts immediately.
When the system detects a FAX (CNG) tone while the OGM is being sent, the call is sent to the
FAX extension assigned in program [503]. When the system detects a cyclic tone or CPC signal
while the OGM is being sent, the call is disconnected.
*12: The DISA Wait Timer After OGM starts. The system waits for a number from the caller during
the time assigned in program [505]. When the system detects a FAX (CNG) tone during the
programmed time, the call is sent to the FAX extension. When the system detects a cyclic tone
or CPC signal during the programmed time, the call is disconnected.
*13: After the DISA Wait Timer After OGM or the Intercept Timer for Internal DISA expires, the
system regards that nothing was dialled.
*14: The system treats the call according to program [510] as follows.
• Disconnect – the call is disconnected.
• Intercept – the call is sent to the extensions programmed in [408]-[410]. If all extensions are
assigned to “Disable”, the call will be disconnected.
*15: The DISA Ring Timer After Intercept starts. The destination telephone(s) will ring for the time
programmed in [509]. If the call is not answered during the programmed time, the call will be
disconnected.
*16: The FAX extension assigned in program [503] receives the call. When the extension is busy, the
system sends a busy tone to the sending FAX. If the call is not answered after 40 seconds, the
call will be disconnected.
Program [514] sets how many times the FAX (CNG) tone must be detected before the system
recognises the incoming signal as facsimile data.
Features
3-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
Display Contrast Adjustment
(KX-T7130 only)
Allows a display proprietary telephone user to adjust the display contrast with the
CONTRAST selector.
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Display Contrast Adjustment”
Distinctive Dial Tones
An extension user will hear 3 types of dial tone patterns which give information about the
features activated on the telephone.
Dial Tone 1: This is a normal dial tone. None of the features listed in Dial Tone 2 are
activated.
1 s
Dial Tone 2: Sent when any of the following features are set.
• Absent Message Capability
• Background Music (BGM)
(for proprietary telephones only)
• Call Pickup Deny
• Call Forwarding
• Data Line Security
• Electronic Extension Lockout
• Do Not Disturb (DND)
• Message Waiting
(for proprietary telephones only)
• Remote Extension Lock Control
• Pickup Dialling
(for single line telephones only)
• Timed Reminder
1 s
Dial Tone 3: Sent when making an Account Code Entry and answering a Timed
Reminder call. Also sent when going off-hook with a single line telephone
which has a message in a Voice Processing System.
1 s
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.7 Useful Features, “Distinctive Dial Tones”
3-28
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
Do Not Disturb (DND)
<Do Not Disturb (DND)>
Allows an extension user to prevent other parties from disturbing them. The extension will
not receive intercom or outside calls.
<Do Not Disturb (DND) Override>
Allows an extension user enabled in program [609] to call an extension which has set the Do
Not Disturb (DND) feature.
• If your proprietary telephone (PT) is not supplied with the FWD/DND button, it can be
assigned to a flexible line key in the Proprietary Telephone Settings.
• DND does not work for the following calls: Hold recall or Timed Reminder.
• A PT user in the DND mode can answer a call by pressing the corresponding flashing
button.
!
• If the Call Forwarding feature has already been set, setting the DND feature will cancel
Call Forwarding.
• Required System Programming
☞
[609] Do Not Disturb Override
• Related Feature References
Call Forwarding,
Timed Reminder
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings,
“Customising the Buttons on
Your Telephone”,
FWD/DND (Forward/Do Not Disturb) Button
1.7 Useful Features, “Rejecting Incoming Calls (Do Not Disturb — DND)”
1.7 Useful Features, “Calling an Extension which Denies Receiving Calls
(Do Not Disturb Override)”
Features
3-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
Door Opener
Up to 4 Door Openers can be connected to the system. The door can be unlocked by a pre-
assigned extension users in programs [703]-[705].
Could you please
open the door?
Panasonic
Just a moment
please.
• An optional Doorphone/Door Opener Card must be installed to the system and a user-
supplied door opener to the door to be opened. Four openers can be installed.
• The door opener will open the door even if a doorphone is not installed.
• The door opener timer can be modified in program [709].
!
• Connection Reference
☞
2.16 Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
• Required System Programming
[703]–[705] Door Opener Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[709] Door Opener Time
• Related Feature Reference
Doorphone Call
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Door Opener”
Doorphone Call
Up to 4 Doorphones (KX-T30865) can be installed. If a visitor presses the doorphone
button, a pre-assigned extension user in programs [700]-[702] can answer the call and talk to
the visitor. Any extension user can call a doorphone. The doorphones are also used for the
Room Monitor feature.
• An optional Doorphone/Door Opener Card must be installed to the system and a
doorphone. Four doorphones can be installed.
• Doorphone 1 and 2 cannot be used simultaneously. When one is in use, an extension user
cannot have a conversation with the other. Doorphone 3 and 4 are the same.
• An access tone can be programmed in [707] to be sent to a monitored doorphone before
room monitoring starts.
!
• The ring tone from the doorphone call is programmable in [706].
3-30
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
D
• Connection Reference
☞
2.16 Doorphone and Door Opener Connection
• Required System Programming
[700]–[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[706] Doorphone Ringing/Tone Pattern Selection
[707] Doorphone Access Tone Selection
[708] Doorphone Ringing Time
• Related Feature References
Door Opener, Room Monitor
• Operating Instructions References
1.7 Useful Features, “Room Monitor”
1.7 Useful Features, “Doorphone Call”
DSS Console
The Direct Station Selection (DSS) Console provides direct access to extensions, a busy
lamp display, as well as 16 PF (Programmable Feature) buttons.
The DSS Console must be programmed to work with a proprietary telephone (PT). The port
number of the DSS Console and its associated PT are assigned in programs [003] and [004].
Up to 2 consoles can be installed per system.
If a feature like One-Touch Dialling is assigned to a DSS button or PF button, accessing the
feature can be done easily by pressing the corresponding button. This is very useful for an
operator or manager. Refer to the Operating Instructions for more details.
• Programming the DSS and PF buttons can be done only from the paired telephone.
• Indicating the Forward (FWD) or Do Not Disturb (DND) status of corresponding
extensions using a DSS button indication is programmable in [112].
!
• Connection Reference
☞
2.8 Extension Connection
• Required System Programming
[003] DSS Console Port Assignment
[004] Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS Console
[112] DSS Console Indication Mode
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.9 DSS Console Features
Features
3-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
Emergency Call
Allows an extension user to access a pre-assigned emergency number which can be dialled
regardless of any restrictions.
• Up to 5 emergency numbers can be stored.
• An emergency call is allowed even in the following cases;
— in Account Code Modes (Verify–All and Forced modes),
— in any call barring COS number, and
!
— in Electronic Extension Lockout.
• Required System Programming
☞
[309] Emergency Dial Number Set
• Related Feature References
Account Code Entry, Call Barring, Extension Lock
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.3 Making Calls, “Making Emergency Calls (Emergency Call)”
Exchange Line Ringing Selection
When an outside call is received at an extension, the user can select whether their extension
will ring or not.
• Select “Enable” in programs [408]–[410].
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[408]–[410] “Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”,
Exchange Line Ringing Selection
3-32
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
Executive Busy Override
<Executive Busy Override – Extension>
Allows an extension user enabled in program [608] to interrupt an existing intercom call. A
3-party conference will be established.
<Executive Busy Override – Exchange Line>
Allows a proprietary telephone user enabled in program [608] to interrupt an existing outside
call or add a third party. A 3-party conference will be established.
<Executive Busy Override Deny>
Allows an extension user to prevent other extension users from interrupting their
conversation.
• The Executive Busy Override feature will not work if the extension engaged the
conversation has set Executive Busy Override Deny or Data Line Security.
• When a 3-party call is changed to a 2-party call or vice versa, a confirmation tone will be
sent to all parties. This tone can be disabled by program [105].
!
• Required System Programming
[105] Conference Tone
☞
[608] Executive Busy Override
• Related Feature Reference
Conference (3-party)
• Operating Instructions References
1.3 Making Calls, “Interrupting an Existing Call (Executive Busy Override)”
1.3 Making Calls, “Denying ‘Interrupting an Existing Call’
(Executive Busy Override Deny)”
Extension Button Confirmation
(KX-T7130 only)
Allows a display proprietary telephone user to confirm the values stored in the buttons, such
as the REDIAL button or flexible line key, by pressing the corresponding button while
on-hook.
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.7 Useful Features “Extension Button Confirmation (KX-T7130 only)”
Features
3-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
Extension Feature Clear
Allows an extension user to reset the following extension features to the default settings.
• Absent Message Capability
• Automatic Callback Busy (Camp-On)
• Background Music (BGM)
• Call Forwarding
• Call Pickup Deny
• Call Waiting
• Data Line Security
• Do Not Disturb (DND)
• Executive Busy Override Deny
• Log-In/Log-Out
• Message Waiting – (All messages will be erased.)
• Pickup Dialling – (The stored telephone number will be erased.)
• Paging Deny
• Room Monitor
• Timed Reminder
• Voice Mail Integration
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.7 Useful Features, “Cancelling the Feature Settings (Extension Feature Clear)”
3-34
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
Extension Group
The system supports 8 extension groups. In an extension group, the following features can
be activated.
• Group Call Pickup: Any member of an extension group can pick up a call directed to
another member in the same group.
• Paging – Group: Any member of an extension group can make a voice
announcement to another group member.
A hunting group, DISA ring group or UCD group is a specific extension group. The
following operation as well as the features above can be activated for a hunting group, DISA
ring group or UCD group.
Hunting Group
An extension group enabled in program [100] “Hunting Group Set” will perform the
Extension Hunting feature. See “Extension Hunting” in this section.
DISA Ring Group
All extensions in a DISA ring group assigned as an auto attendant destination in
program [501] “DISA Built-in Auto Attendant” will ring simultaneously. Selecting
“DISA1” or “DISA2” in programs [414]–[416] “Exchange Line Mode —
Day/Night/Lunch” is required. Also, you must select “With AA” in program [500]
“DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection”.
UCD Group
One extension group assigned as the UCD group in program [520] “UCD Group” can
be the destination of incoming outside calls via the UCD feature. Selecting “UCD” in
programs [414]–[416] “Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch” is required.
• Required System Program Address
☞
[600] Extension Group Assignment
• Related Feature References
Call Pickup, Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Extension Hunting,
Paging, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
Features
3-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
Extension Hunting
If a called extension is busy, Extension Hunting redirects the incoming call to an idle
extension in an extension group in numerical order. Idle extensions are automatically hunted
according to programming. The following 2 hunting types are available.
Circular hunting:
The extensions are hunted one time in numerical order. If all
extensions are busy, a busy tone will be heard.
Terminate hunting: The extensions are hunted until the extension which has the
highest port number in the group is reached. If all higher order
numbers are busy, the search will end and a busy tone will be
heard.
• One hunting type can be selected for each extension group.
• To leave the hunting group temporarily, use the Log-Out feature. To rejoin, use the
Log-In feature.
• If the called extension has set Do Not Disturb (DND), Call Forwarding or Log-Out,
Extension Hunting will skip the extension. However, Extension Hunting will not skip the
extension which receives the call first, even if it has set Do Not Disturb (DND) or Call
Forwarding.
!
Circular Hunting
Terminate
• Required System Programming
[100] Hunting Group Set
☞
[101] Hunting Type
[600] Extension Group Assignment
• Related Feature References
Call Forwarding
Do Not Disturb (DND)
Extension Group
Log-In/Log-Out
Busy Tone
Extension Lock
<Electronic Extension Lockout>
Allows an extension user to lock their extension so that other users
cannot make outside calls until it is unlocked. Any 4-digit code can
be used to lock and unlock an extension.
<Electronic Extension Lockout – CANCEL ALL>
The operator and manager can cancel Electronic Extension Lockout
of all extensions at one time.
<Remote Extension Lock Control>
The operator and manager are given the privilege of controlling Electronic Extension
Lockout at any extension by using the DSS console. The operator and manager can see the
status of each extension, locked or unlocked, by the pre-assigned DSS button LED on the
DSS console. For example, this feature is useful for a small hotel or motel when guests are
checked out.
3-36
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
• The Remote Extension Lock Control overrides the Electronic Extension Lockout. If the
operator or manager sets Remote Extension Lock on an extension that has already been
locked by the extension user, the user cannot unlock it.
• A call barring class can be assigned to an extension which has set the Electronic
Extension Lockout and Remote Extension Lock Control features in program [312] “Call
Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class”. Certain types of outgoing outside calls are
allowed depending on the assigned call barring class.
!
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.6 Before Leaving Your Desk, “Locking Your Telephone (Electronic Extension
Lockout)”
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Electronic Extension Lockout – CANCEL
ALL”
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Remote Extension Lock”
1.9 DSS Console Features “Initial Settings”, Extension Lock Button Assignment
(Operator/Manager only)
Extension Password / System Password
The extension password assigned by the manager (extension port 01) to each extension can
be used for the Walking COS feature.
The system password is used for entering System Programming and also before assigning
the extension password.
• Required System Programming
☞
[002] System Password
• Related Feature References
Walking COS
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Extension Password Set (Manager only)”
Features
3-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
E
External Feature Access
Allows an extension user to access special features (e.g. Call Waiting) offered by the Local
Exchange or host PBX. This is done by placing the current call on hold and sending a recall
signal using either the RECALL button or the feature number. This feature is effective only
during an outside call.
• When “MODE2” is selected in program [110] and the RECALL button is pressed for
longer than the time programmed in [418], this feature will not work.
• The recall time must be assigned in program [418] as required by the host PBX or
exchange line.
!
• Required System Programming
[110] Recall Key Mode
[418] Recall Time
☞
• Related Feature References
Host PBX Access, Recall
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “External Feature Access”
3-38
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
F
Flexible Buttons
A proprietary telephone (PT) user can change the flexible buttons on the telephone and DSS
console to certain function buttons. For example, if the telephone has more line keys than
available exchange lines, the unused line keys may be changed to One-Touch Dialling
buttons, etc.
The 4 types of flexible buttons are as follows:
• Flexible line keys (located on a PT only)
• Flexible DSS Buttons (located on a DSS Console only)
• Programmable Feature (PF) Buttons (located on a PT and DSS Console)
• Flexible MESSAGE Buttons
Check the required operation first. If the telephone is not provided with the button, assigning
the button can be performed in the Proprietary Telephone Settings.
Programmable Button
Function
LINE
DSS
PF
MESSAGE
DSS (Direct Station Selection)
One-Touch Dialling
CONF (Conference)
FWD/DND (Forward/Do Not Disturb)
SAVE
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
Log-In/Log-Out
Single Exchange Line (S-CO)
Other Exchange Line (O-CO)
Trunk Group (G-CO)
MESSAGE (Message Waiting)
Day
✔
✔
✔
✔
✔
Night
Lunch
Extension Lock
“✔” indicates that the feature is available.
•
Operating Instructions Reference
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”
☞
Features
3-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
H
Handsfree Answerback
Allows a proprietary telephone with a speakerphone to answer an intercom call without
lifting the handset. This feature performed by pressing the AUTO ANSWER/MUTE button.
• This feature does not work for incoming outside calls or doorphone calls.
!
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.4 Receiving Calls, “Handsfree Answerback”
Handsfree Operation
Allows a proprietary telephone user to dial and talk to the other party without lifting the
handset. Pressing one of the following buttons activates the handsfree mode when the
SP-PHONE/MONITOR button indicator is off:
SP-PHONE button, MONITOR button, INTERCOM button, or line key.
• The KX-T7050 can perform handsfree dialling operations, etc., but cannot have a
handsfree conversation.
!
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.3 Making Calls, “Handsfree Operation”
Hold
<Call Hold>
Allows an extension user to place an intercom and/or outside call on hold. The held call can
be retrieved by the user who held it, or by any other extension (Call Hold Retrieve).
With a single line telephone (SLT), either one outside or intercom call can be held at one
time. If an SLT user wants to hold both calls, use the Call Park feature. An SLT user can
select how to operate the Call Hold feature by program [104].
<Exclusive Hold>
Allows a proprietary telephone user to prevent other extension users from retrieving their
held call. Only the user who held the call can retrieve it. This feature is not available for an
SLT.
3-40
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
H
• Only one intercom call can be placed on hold. For a proprietary telephone, outside calls
and one intercom call can be placed on hold at the same time.
!
• If a held call is not retrieved within the assigned time in program [200], the extension
user who held it will hear a ring tone or an alarm tone. If the user is on-hook and their
SP-PHONE/MONITOR button indicator is off, the phone will ring (Hold Recall). If the
user is off-hook or in the handsfree mode, an alarm tone will be sent to the built-in
speaker of a proprietary telephone or the handset receiver of a single line telephone at
15-second intervals (Hold Alarm). If “Disable” is selected in program [200], nothing will
be heard.
• If a held outside call is not answered within thirty minutes, it will be automatically
disconnected.
• For outside calls, music is sent to the external party on hold, if available (Music on Hold).
• During a 5-party conference, the Hold feature cannot be activated.
• Required System Programming
[104] Hold Mode Selection
[200] Hold Recall Time
☞
• Related Feature References
Call Park, Music on Hold/Background Music (BGM),
Recall Button on a Single Line Telephone
• Operating Instructions References
1.5 During a Conversation, “Placing a Call on Hold (Call Hold)”
1.5 During a Conversation, “Placing a Call on Hold Exclusively (Exclusive Hold)”
1.5 During a Conversation, “Retrieving a Call on Hold (Call Hold Retrieve)”
Host PBX Access
The system may be installed behind an existing host PBX. This is performed by connecting
a line from the host to an exchange line in the system.
• A Host PBX Access code assigned in program [403] is required to access an exchange
line of the host PBX.
• Access to the host PBX during a conversation is also possible (External Feature Access).
!
• Required System Programming
[403] Host PBX Access Codes
[417] Pause Time
☞
• Related Feature Reference
External Feature Access
To Central Office
Host PBX
Features
3-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
I
Intercept Routing
Provides automatic redirection of incoming outside calls via the DISA or UCD feature. The
Intercept Routing feature works in the following 2 cases.
1) When nothing is dialled after a dial tone or OGM is sent to the caller. (The DISA feature
only)
2) When the call is not answered within a programmed time. This is called Intercept
Routing – No Answer (IRNA).
• Required System Programming
[408]–[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[507] DISA Intercept Mode
☞
[508] DISA Ringing Time before Intercept
[509] DISA Ringing Time after Intercept
[510] DISA No Dial Mode
[523] UCD Busy Mode
[524] UCD Intercept Mode
[525] UCD Ringing Time before Intercept
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept
• Related Feature References
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
Intercom Calling
Allows an extension user to make a call to another extension.
• An extension number and a name can be assigned in programs [009] and [604]. If
assigned, they will be shown on the display proprietary telephone during an intercom call.
• The DSS buttons permit a proprietary telephone user one-touch access to an extension.
The DSS function can be assigned to a flexible line key in the Proprietary Telephone
Settings.
!
The DSS buttons on the DSS console can also be used.
• An extension user can press the DSS buttons directly to make an intercom call without
going off-hook. This can be enabled by program [126].
• Required System Programming
[009] Extension Number Assignment
[126] DSS Off-Hook Mode
☞
[604] Extension Name Setting
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
DSS (Direct Station Selection) Button
1.3 Making Calls, “Intercom Calling”
1.9 DSS Console Features, “Initial Settings”, Extension Number Assignment
3-42
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
L
Language Selection
The selected language in program [615] is shown on the LCD display of a proprietary
telephone during operation and Proprietary Telephone Settings, but not used during System
Programming. The selected language in program [806] is used for an SMDR printout.
• Required System Programming
[615] LCD Language Assignment
[806] SMDR Language Assignment
☞
Limited Call Duration
The system disconnects outside outgoing calls when a specific timer expires. The timer is in
effect when making an outside call, transferring an intercom call to an exchange line or
forwarding an intercom call to an exchange line. Limiting the time of the call can be
assigned through System Programming.
• An alarm tone will be sent to both parties 15 seconds before the assigned time limit.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[212] Exchange line Duration Time Limit
[613] Exchange line Duration Time Limit Selection
• Related Feature References
Call Forwarding, Call Transfer – to Exchange line
Line Access Keys
A proprietary telephone (PT) user must assign one of the following 3 types of line keys to
flexible line keys in the Proprietary Telephone Settings. This permits making or receiving
outside calls. The default setting for the flexible line keys (CO 1 – CO 6) are Single
Exchange Line (S-CO) keys. CO 1 corresponds to exchange line 1, CO 2 corresponds to
exchange line 2, etc.
<Trunk Group (G-CO) Key>
Receiving or making outside calls is on an trunk group basis. The trunk group is assigned in
program [404]. Any incoming call from any exchange line in the trunk group arrives at the
G-CO key. To make an outside call, the user can access an idle exchange line in the group
by simply pressing the assigned G-CO key.
<Single Exchange Line (S-CO) Key>
Receiving or making outside calls is done using a specific exchange line. An incoming call
from the specific exchange line arrives at the S-CO key. To make an outside call, the user
can access the specific exchange line by simply pressing the assigned S-CO key.
<Other Exchange Line (O-CO) Key>
Exchange lines, which are not assigned to an S-CO or G-CO key, can be assigned to a
flexible line key as the O-CO key. An incoming call on an exchange lines arrives at the
O-CO. To make an outside call, the user simply presses the assigned O-CO key.
Features
3-43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
L
• The same trunk group can be assigned to more than one G-CO key on the same PT.
• The same line can be assigned to an S-CO key and G-CO key. The
S-CO key has priority.
• Immediate, delayed, no ringing or no incoming calls (disable) can be selected by
programs [408] through [413] on an extension-exchange line basis.
• A ringing pattern can be selected for each exchange line by program [423].
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment
[404] Trunk Group Assignment
[405]–[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[408]–[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[411]–[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection
• Related Feature References
Outside Calling, Receiving Calls, Ringing Pattern Selection
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Line Access Keys
Log-In/Log-Out
Allows an extension user to Log-In (join) or Log-Out (leave) a hunting, DISA ring or UCD
group temporarily. Extensions in the log-out mode will not receive calls by Extension
Hunting, DISA or UCD but will receive other calls, not like the Do Not Disturb (DND)
feature. The Log-In/Log-Out button can be assigned to a flexible button in the Proprietary
Telephone Settings. The lighting patterns of the Log-In/Log-Out button on a proprietary
telephone and status are as follows.
Log-In
Off: Log-In mode
Red: Log-Out mode
• There should be at least one extension that is in the
Log-In mode in a group.
!
☞
Log-Out
• Related Feature References
UCD Group
Direct Inward System Access (DISA),
Hunting Group
DISA Ring Group
Extension Group,
Extension Hunting, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Log-In/Log-Out Button
1.7 Useful Features, “Joining or Leaving a Call Distribution Group (Log-In/Log-Out)”
3-44
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
M
Message Waiting
Allows an extension user to notify the called extension of a message waiting when the called
extension is busy or does not answer the call. Only a proprietary telephone user with a
MESSAGE button can know there is a message waiting if the LED on the MESSAGE button
lights red. Pressing the lit MESSAGE button will reply to the message by calling the
extension which left the message. The messages which are stored in the mailbox of the
Voice Processing System can also be heard by following the Voice Mail prompts after
pressing the lit MESSAGE button (Voice Mail Integration).
• Cancelling the message can be performed from the extension sending it or from the
extension receiving it.
• Each extension can have a maximum of 8 simultaneous messages.
• Messages are always left at the original extension. They cannot be sent to a Call
Forwarding or Extension Hunting destination.
!
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Restoring the MESSAGE button
1.7 Useful Features, “Leaving a Message Notification (Message Waiting)”
1.7 Useful Features, “Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100”
Microphone Mute
Allows a proprietary telephone user to turn off the microphone for privacy.
• The user’s voice will only be muted during a handsfree conversation. The user can hear
the other party’s voice during Microphone Mute.
!
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.5 During a Conversation, “Turning off the Microphone (Microphone Mute)”
Features
3-45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
M-O
Music on Hold / Background Music (BGM)
While an external party is on hold, music is automatically generated.
• Operations such as Call Hold and Call Transfer activate Music on Hold.
• A user-supplied external music source, such as a radio, must be connected to the system
when “External” is selected in program [111]. One external music source can be
connected to the system. The music source is used for Music on Hold and/or BGM.
• When “Tone” is selected in program [111], the cyclic tone is used only for Music on
Hold and the external music source is used for BGM.
!
• Connection Reference
☞
2.10 External Music Connection
• Required System Programming
[111] Hold Music Selection
• Related Feature References
Hold, Call Transfer – to Exchange line, Call Transfer – to Extension,
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Turning on the Background Music (BGM)”
One-Touch Dialling
Allows a proprietary telephone user one-touch access to a desired party or system feature.
This is done by storing an extension number, telephone number or a feature number (up to
24 digits) in a One-Touch Dialling button. One-Touch Dialling buttons can be assigned to
flexible buttons in the Proprietary Telephone Settings.
• An account code can be stored into a One-Touch Dialling button.
• A number consisting of 25 digits or more can be stored by dividing it and storing it in
2 One-Touch Dialling buttons.
!
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”
One-Touch Dialling button
1.3 Making Calls, “Dialling by Simply Pressing a Button (One-Touch Dialling)”
1.9 DSS Console Features, “Initial Settings”
1.9 DSS Console Features, “One-Touch Dialling”
1.9 DSS Console Features, “One-Touch Access for System Features”
3-46
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
Operator / Manager Extension
The system supports one operator. Any extension can be designated as an operator in
program [008]. Extension port 01 is the system manager extension. The extension assigned
as an operator or manager has the ability to perform the following operations.
• Setting the Date and Time
• Cancelling the Electronic Extension Lockout
• Setting/Cancelling the Remote Extension Lock
• Setting/Cancelling/Confirming the Timed Reminder (Wake-up Call) Remotely
• Recording and Playing the Outgoing Message
• Changing the Day/Night/Lunch Mode
The manager extension can also perform System Programming and the following operation.
• Setting the Extension Password
• Required System Programming
☞
[008] Operator Assignment
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features
Operator Call
Allows an extension user to call an operator within the system by dialling the feature number
assigned in program [121]. One extension can be assigned as the operator in program [008].
• If an operator is not assigned, this feature is not available and a reorder tone will be
heard.
• Every extension user can reach the operator just by dialling the operator call number (0 or
9) assigned in program [121] “Automatic Exchange Line Access Number Selection”.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[008] Operator Assignment
[121] Automatic Exchange Line Access Number Selection
• Related Feature Reference
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.3 Making Calls, “Calling an Operator (Operator Call)”
Features
3-47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
Outgoing Message (OGM)
Allows the extension assigned as an operator or manager to record up to 2 outgoing voice
messages (maximum 30 seconds each). This message is played when a caller accesses the
DISA or UCD feature. An optional OGM/FAX Detection Card is required to program the
OGM.
The following are some examples of OGM and flow chart.
Case 1: Receives 2 calls at a time – OGM for DISA.
(Do not want customers to be kept waiting.)
System
DISA with
OGM1
OGM2
OGM
Outside Call
To the designated destination
DISA with
OGM
Outside Call
To the designated destination
OGM1: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.”
OGM2: Same as OGM 1
Required Settings: [502] “MODE1”
[414]-[416] “DISA1”
Case 2: Uses the OGM in the day, night and lunch modes – OGM for DISA.
System
(In the day mode)
DISA with
OGM
OGM1
OGM2
Outside Call
To the designated destination
System
(In the night mode)
DISA with
OGM
The call is disconnected by assigning
“Disconnect” for DISA2 in program
[510] “DISA No Dial Mode”.
Outside Call
OGM1: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.”
OGM2: “We are sorry but our office is closed for the day.”
Required Settings: [502] “MODE2”
[414]-[416] “DISA1” for OGM1, “DISA2” for OGM2
3-48
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
Case 3: Uses a different OGM for exchange lines – OGM for DISA.
System
(Exchange line 1)
Outside Call
DISA with
OGM
OGM1
OGM2
To the designated destination
To the designated destination
(Exchange line 2)
Outside Call
DISA with
OGM
OGM1: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.”
OGM2: “This is B company. To contact Mr. A, press 101. To contact Mr. B, press
102.”
Required Settings: [502] “MODE2”
[414]-[416] “DISA1” for the A company exchange line(s).
“DISA2” for the B company exchange line(s).
Case 4: Uses a different OGM when the line is busy – OGM for DISA.
System
DISA with
OGM1
OGM
To the designated destination
Outside Call
DISA with
OGM
The line is busy.
(If the operator is selected.)
To the Operator
OGM2
OGM1: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.”
OGM2: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy. If you want to call the operator,
press 0.”
Required Settings: [502] “MODE2”
[414]-[416] “DISA1”
[506] “DISA2”
Case 5: Distributes calls to the UCD group – OGM for UCD.
System
UCD with
The line is busy.
OGM
(When the line is free.)
Outside Call
OGM1
UCD with
OGM
To the UCD group
The line is busy.
(When the line is free.)
Outside Call
OGM2
OGM1: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy. Please hold.”
OGM2: Same as OGM1
Required Settings: [502] “MODE3”
[414]-[416] “UCD”
Features
3-49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
Case 6: Disconnects a call after the OGM – OGM for UCD.
System
UCD with
OGM1
OGM
The line is busy.
Outside Call
OGM2
The call is disconnected.
OGM1: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy. Please hold.”
OGM2: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy. Please call back later.”
Required Settings: [502] “MODE4”
[414]-[416] “UCD”
Case 7: Uses the DISA or UCD feature for exchange lines
– OGM for DISA and UCD.
System
(UCD)
UCD with
OGM
The line is busy.
(When the line is free.)
Outside Call
To the UCD group
OGM1
(DISA)
DISA with
OGM
OGM2
Outside Call
To the designated destination
OGM1: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy Please hold.” (UCD message)
OGM2: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.” (DISA message)
Required Settings: [502] “MODE5”
[414]-[416] “DISA1” for exchange line(s) which use the DISA
feature
“UCD” for exchange line(s) which use the UCD
feature
Case 8: Uses the DISA feature when none of the extension in the UCD group can
answer a call – OGM for UCD.
System
UCD with
OGM1
OGM
The line is busy.
Outside Call
OGM2
The call is sent to the DISA feature.
OGM1: “We are sorry. The line is currently busy Please hold.”
OGM2: “This is A company. For the sales division, press 1. For the service
division, press 2. To call the operator, press 0.”
Required Settings: [502] “MODE6”
[414]-[416] “UCD”
[523] “Intercept”
3-50
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
• An optional OGM/FAX Detection Card is required to program the OGM.
!
☞
• Connection Reference
2.15 OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation
• Required System Programming
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
[502] OGM Mode Selection
[506] DISA Busy Mode
[523] UCD Busy Mode
• Related Feature References
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Outgoing Message (OGM)”
Features
3-51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
O
Outside Calling
Allows an extension user to make a call to an external party by using one of the following
line access methods.
<Automatic Line Access>
Allows an extension user to select an available exchange line automatically from the
assigned lines in program [419] by pressing the Automatic Line Access number (0 or 9). For
a proprietary telephone, a Line Access Key assignment (S-CO, G-CO, O-CO) in the
Proprietary Telephone Settings is required. If Idle Line Preference is set on the telephone in
the Proprietary Telephone Settings, the user can access an idle line only by going off-hook.
<Individual Line Access>
Allows a proprietary telephone user to select the desired exchange line by pressing the line
key assigned as the S-CO key. A Line Access Key assignment (S-CO) is required before
use.
<Trunk Group Access>
Allows an extension user to select an idle line within a designated trunk group. A trunk
group is assigned in program [404]. To specify a trunk group, dial the feature number “8”
and the desired trunk group number (1 through 6). A proprietary telephone user can also
specify a trunk group by pressing a G-CO key. A Line Access Key assignment (G-CO) is
required before use. If Idle Line Preference is set on the telephone in the Proprietary
Telephone Settings, the user can access an idle line only by going off-hook.
• Each extension requires System Programming to access exchange lines.
• After an exchange line is seized, the system waits for the assigned time in program [206]
before dialling.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[206] Dialling Start Time
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment
[404] Trunk Group Assignment
[405]–[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access
• Related Feature References
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number
Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing, Line Access Keys
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”,
Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Line Access Keys
1.3 Making Calls, “Outside Calling”
3-52
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P
Paging
Allows an extension user to make a voice announcement to several people at the same time.
The message is announced over the built-in speakers of proprietary telephones and/or the
external pager. The paged person can answer the page (Answering a Page) from any
extension within the system. The following types are available.
All Extensions:
Makes a voice announcement to all extensions over the built-in
speakers of proprietary telephones.
Group:
Makes a voice announcement to the designated extension group over
the built-in speakers of proprietary telephones. An extension group is
assigned in program [600] “Extension Group Assignment”.
Makes a voice announcement over the external pager.
External:
All Extensions & : Makes a voice announcement to all extensions over the built-in
External
speakers of proprietary telephones and the external pager.
• An extension user can also transfer a call after paging (Paging and Transfer). Also, pages
can be denied (Paging Deny).
• An external pager (user-supplied) must be connected beforehand. One external pager can
be connected to the system.
!
• A confirmation tone is sent to the extensions before the voice announcement or
answering.
• A confirmation tone is sent to the external pager before the voice announcement. The
tone to the external pager can be disabled in program [106].
• An extension which has set the Do Not Disturb (DND) or Paging Deny feature, or is in
use cannot be paged.
• Connection Reference
☞
2.9 External Pager (Paging Equipment) Connection
• Required System Programming
[106] External Paging Access Tone
• Related Feature References
Extension Group, Do Not Disturb (DND)
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.5 During a Conversation, “Paging”
Features
3-53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P
Parallelled Telephone Connection
Any analogue proprietary telephone can be connected in parallel with a single line device,
such as a single line telephone, facsimile and data terminal.
• System Programming is required.
!
• Connection Reference
☞
2.11 Parallelled Telephone Connection
• Required System Programming
[610] Parallelled Telephone Connection
• Related Feature Reference
Power Failure Transfer
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Parallel Connection of a Proprietary Telephone and Single Line
Telephone (Parallelled Telephone Connection)”
Personal Speed Dialling
Allows an extension user to store up to 10 speed dialling numbers (0 through 9) with a
maximum of 24 digits per number. An extension number, telephone number or feature
number can be stored. For example, storing extension numbers for each room in a house can
be useful. (1 = Living Room, 2 = Kitchen, etc.) To make a call, dial # and the number.
• Proprietary telephone users cannot use this feature if One-Touch Dialling buttons are
assigned to PF buttons. If the user assign a personal speed dialling number, the number
stored in the One-Touch Dialling button will be overwritten and vice versa. PF Buttons
F1 through F10 correspond to the speed dialling numbers as follows.
!
F1 — 0
F2 — 1
F3 — 2
F4 — 3
F5 — 4
F6 — 5
F7 — 6
F8 — 7
F9 — 8
F10 — 9
• A rotary telephone user cannot use this feature.
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.3 Making Call, “Dialling with Personal Speed Dialling (Personal Speed Dialling)”
3-54
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P
Pickup Dialling
Allows a single line telephone user to make an outgoing call by going off-hook, if the user
has stored the telephone number (up to 32 digits) beforehand. This feature is also known as
Hot Line.
• A rotary telephone cannot program this feature.
• The user can set and cancel this feature.
!
• If the feature is activated and the user goes off-hook, a dial tone will be generated for the
delay time assigned in program [203] and then dialling will start. During the delay time,
the user can dial another party overriding the Pickup Dialling function.
• Required System Programming
☞
[203] Pickup Dial Delay Time
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.3 Making Call, “Dialling by Simply Going Off-Hook (Pickup Dialling)”
Polarity Reverse Detection
The circuit in the system can detect an exchange line polarity reverse signal from the Local
Exchange when trying to make an outside call. This detects the start (a called party goes
off-hook) and end (the called party goes on-hook) of an outgoing outside call. The
conversation time can be verified on the SMDR printout using this feature.
When an outside call is received, the circuit can also detect the polarity reverse signal before
ringing.
• Required System Programming
☞
[424] Reverse (Polarity) Circuit Assignment
• Related Feature Reference
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
Features
3-55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P
Power Failure Transfer
During a power failure, specific extension telephones are automatically connected to specific
exchange lines. This provides exchange line conversations between the following extensions
and exchange lines.
Exchange line 1 : extension port 01
Exchange line 4 : extension port 09
A single line telephone (SLT) can work in case of a power failure. Connect an SLT to the
above extension port. For more information, refer to the Operating Instructions.
• All other conversations, except the above combinations, are disconnected during a power
failure.
• Only an exchange line can have a conversation. All other features do not work.
• We recommend connecting a single line telephone (SLT) in parallel at extension ports 01
and 09, so that an SLT can be used during a power failure.
!
• Connection Reference
2.18 Auxiliary Connection for Power Failure Transfer
• Related Feature Reference
☞
Parallelled Telephone Connection
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Power Failure Transfer”
Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming
A proprietary telephone user can select the method to answer incoming outside calls from
the following 3 line preferences. System Programming and Proprietary Telephone Settings
are required.
No Line Preference:
When an incoming call is received, the extension user must go
off-hook and then press the flashing line key.
Prime Line Preference: When incoming calls are received at the same time, the user
can receive the call on the preferred exchange line by only
going off-hook.
Ringing Line Preference: When an incoming call is received, the user can receive the
call ringing at their telephone by going off-hook.
• A single line telephone can only set “Ringing Line Preference”.
• Line access key(s) (Single Exchange Line, Other Exchange Line or Trunk Group) should
be assigned to line key(s) beforehand.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[408]–[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[411]–[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
• Related Feature Reference
Line Access Keys
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”,
Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Line Access Keys
3-56
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P
Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing
A proprietary telephone user can select a desired outgoing line preference to make outside
calls from the following 3 line preferences. System Programming and Proprietary Telephone
Settings are required.
Idle Line Preference: When the user goes off-hook, they are connected to an idle line.
An idle line is automatically selected from the pre-assigned
lines in program [419].
Prime Line Preference: When the user goes off-hook, they are connected to the
pre-assigned line. Assign one prime line beforehand.
No Line Preference:
No line is selected when the user goes off-hook. They must
select a line to make a call.
• Line Access Key(s) (Single Exchange Line, Other Exchange Line or Trunk Group) should
be assigned to the line key(s) beforehand.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment
[405]–[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access
• Related Feature Reference
Line Access Keys
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”,
Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Line Access Keys
Proprietary Telephone Setting Data Default Set
Allows a proprietary telephone user to reset the following Proprietary Telephone Settings to
the default settings.
• Preferred Line Assignment — Outgoing
• Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming
• Exchange Line Ringing Selection
• Intercom Alert Assignment
• Call Waiting Tone Selection
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising Your Telephone Functions”,
Proprietary Telephone Setting Data Default Set
Features
3-57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
P-R
Pulse to Tone Conversion
Allows an extension user to change the dialling mode from Pulse to Tone after entering a
telephone number to access services, such as computer telephone services or Voice Mail,
which require tones.
• This feature only works for exchange lines which have set “Pulse Mode” or ”Call
Blocking Mode” in program [401].
• Changing from Tone to Pulse is not possible.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[401] Dial Mode
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Pulse to Tone Conversion”
Recall
The RECALL button is used to allow a proprietary telephone user to disconnect the current
call and originate another call without hanging up. This is activated when “MODE2” is
selected in program [110] and the RECALL button is pressed for longer than the time
programmed in [418]. When “MODE1” is selected in program [110], the RECALL button
can be used to access features of the Local Exchange or host PBX (External Feature Access).
It is performed by putting the current party on hold and sending a recall signal while having
an outside call.
• Assigning the External Feature Access feature to any flexible button is useful when
“MODE 2” was selected in program [110]. This can be done from any extension by
assigning the RECALL button to a One-Touch Dialling button (☞ Operating Instructions,
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
One-Touch Access for System Features). When the assigned button is pressed, a recall
signal is sent during the programmed time in [418].
!
• Required System Program Address
[110] Recall Key Mode
☞
[418] Recall Time
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “External Feature Access”
3-58
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
R
Recall Button on a Single Line Telephone
Pressing the Recall button is used to allow a single line telephone user to hold a call for
transferring or holding, if the recall time is within the assigned time in program [207]. The
procedure to transfer a call or hold is determined in program [104] “Hold Mode Selection”.
Pressing the Recall button can be also used to disconnect a call, if the recall time is more
than the assigned time in program [207].
• If “MODE 1” was selected in program [207], the system will recognise pressing the
Recall button as hooking, while a busy tone or reorder tone is sent or during a
conversation. The system will recognise as 1 being dialled in the pulse mode, while a
dial tone is sent. The system can refuse receiving a pulse signal by selecting “Disable” in
program [614]. Therefore, even if the Recall button is pressed during a dial tone, the
system will regard it as hooking.
!
• Required System Programming
[207] Recall Timing Range Selection
[614] Internal Pulse Detection
☞
Receiving Calls
Allows an extension user to receive an intercom or outside call by going off-hook. A
proprietary telephone user can also receive a call by pressing the rapid flashing CO or
INTERCOM button, and talk (handsfree mode) if the telephone has the SP-PHONE button.
• A proprietary telephone user can select the Line Preference for incoming outside calls.
See “Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming” in this section.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[408]–[410] “Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch”
[411]–[413] “Delayed Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch”
• Related Feature Reference
Preferred Line Assignment — Incoming
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.4 Receiving Calls, “Receiving Calls”
Features
3-59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
R
Redial
<Last Number Redial>
Every extension automatically saves the last telephone number dialled so that the extension
user can make a call to the same party later using a simple operation.
<Saved Number Redial>
Allows a proprietary telephone user to save the current external telephone number in the
SAVE button during a conversation, so that the extension user can redial the same party later
using a simple operation. The saved number can be redialled until another number is stored.
A flexible button can be assigned as the SAVE button in the Proprietary Telephone Settings.
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
SAVE button
1.3 Making Calls, “Redialling the Last Number Dialled (Last Number Redial)”
1.3 Making Calls, “Redialling the Saved Number (Saved Number Redial)”
Ringing Pattern Selection
A ringing pattern can be selected depending on the type of call such as an outside call,
intercom call and doorphone call. Available ringing patterns are as follows:
1 s
Single:
Double:
Triple:
S-Double:
(Doorphone only)
• Private calls can be distinguished from business calls by assigning different ringing per
exchange line. Moreover, by assigning different ringing, intercom calls and doorphone
calls can be distinguished from other calls. Therefore, careful attention should be applied
to all ringing assignments.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[115] Extension Ringing Pattern Selection
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection
[706] Doorphone Ringing/Tone Pattern Selection
• Related Feature Reference
Exchange Line Ringing Selection
3-60
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
R
Room Monitor
Allows a proprietary telephone or single line telephone with a MUTE button to monitor a
room or the front door through another proprietary telephone or doorphone without them
knowing. The access tone will not be sent to the monitored proprietary telephone when
monitoring starts.
• The extensions that can be monitored must be programmed in [612] before operation is
possible.
• If a doorphone is used as a room monitor, the access tone will be heard when monitoring
starts as the default setting. The tone can be disabled in program [707].
• This feature is not available for KX-T7050.
!
• A single line telephone with a MUTE button can be used for monitoring, but cannot be
monitored.
• Required System Programming
[612] Room Monitor Assignment
[707] Doorphone Access Tone Selection
☞
• Related Feature Reference
Doorphone Call
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Room Monitor”
Features
3-61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
S
Secret Dialling
Allows a proprietary telephone user to conceal all or part(s) of a System Speed Dialling
number assigned in program [001] or One-Touch Dialling number assigned to a flexible
button in the Proprietary Telephone Settings which would normally appear on the display.
• When storing a number, press the INTERCOM button at the beginning and the end of the
numbers to be concealed.
• One or more parts of a telephone number can be concealed.
• Printing out the concealed number on a SMDR can be assigned in program [803].
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[803] Secret Speed Dialling/One-Touch Dialling Printing
• Related Feature References
One-Touch Dialling, System Speed Dialling
• Operating Instructions References
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
One-Touch Dialling Button
1.7 Useful Features, “Secret Dialling”
Self-Extension Number Confirmation
(KX-T7130 only)
Allows a display proprietary telephone user to confirm their port and extension number using
a simple operation.
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.7 Useful Features, “Self-Extension Number Confirmation
(KX-T7130 only)”
3-62
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
S
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) automatically prints out detailed call information
of outside calls. A printer connected to the Serial Interface (RS-232C) port can be used to
print incoming and outgoing outside calls, as well as print a hard copy of System
Programming. To print out the record of System Programming items that have been
assigned, use program [804] “System Data Dump”. To print the call records, use program
[802] “Incoming/ Outgoing Call Selection for Printing”, which prints out the following
records.
• A record of all outgoing outside calls or outgoing toll calls
• A record of all incoming outside calls
An example of a printed call record:
Date
Time
Ext.
CO
Dial number
Duration
Code
31/12/98 12:52PM 203
31/12/98 12:53PM 203
31/12/98 *12:54PM 201
31/12/98 1:04PM 203
31/12/98 1:04PM 202
31/12/98 1:05PM 203
31/12/98 1:06PM 203
31/12/98 1:06PM 202
31/12/98 1:07PM 203
31/12/98 2:15PM 203
31/12/98 2:26PM 203
31/12/98 2:27PM 216
31/12/98 3:25PM
05
02
02
06
05
01
01
02
01
01
01
05
02
12345678901234567890123456789012
00:00'16
00:01'43
00:07'48
00:00'06
00:00'09
00:00'08
00:00'08
00:00'17
00:11'00
00:11'00
00:03'00
00:13'55
00:11'48
. ...
. ...
. ...
4536
. ...
. ...
. ...
. ...
.. 13
. 201
. ...
. ...
. ...
<
<
incoming
incoming
>
>
092. . . 1438
<
<
DISA incoming
DISA incoming
>
>
092123456789
0921234567
0921234567
0921234567
F/0927654321
9=0924567123
<
UCD Waiting
>
Example of the SMDR printout format:
Explanation
(1) Date : shows the date of the call as Day/Month/Year.
(2) Time : shows the time the call was started as Hour: Minute/AM or PM.
“ ” indicates a transferred call.
*
(3) Ext. : shows the extension number, etc. that engaged in the call.
(4) CO : shows the exchange line number used for the call.
(5) Dial number
Outgoing call:
Shows the called party’s telephone number (maximum 32 digits).
Valid digits are 0 through 9, #,
was pressed).
and P (if the PAUSE button
Received call:
Shows <incoming>. An incoming call via the DISA feature is
shown as <DISA incoming>, via the DIL feature is shown as
<DIL incoming>.
UCD waiting call: Shows <UCD waiting> for an incoming call via the UCD feature.
When the “UCD waiting call” is answered, it becomes a
“Received call” and a new record is started.
Features
3-63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
S
(6) Duration : shows the duration of the call or the UCD call waiting time in
Hours/Minutes/Seconds.
(7) Code: shows the account code appended to the call, account code index number
(e.g.: 13) or the extension number which uses the Walking COS feature
(e.g.: 201).
• This system can store information of up to 64 calls.
• This data is not deleted even when the system is reset.
!
• If RECALL is manually sent out during a conversation to make another call without
hanging up, etc., a call record will be printed and a new record started. “F/” will be
printed at the beginning of the dial number on the new record.
• When a host PBX code is entered, “=” will be printed between the code and dialled
number.
• The language used for an SMDR printout can be selected in program [806].
• Connection Reference
☞
2.13 Printer and PC Connection
• Required System Programming
[000] Date and Time Setting
[204] Call Duration Count Start Time
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters
[801] SMDR Parameter
[802] Incoming/Outgoing Call Selection for Printing
[803] Secret Speed Dialling/One-Touch Dialling Printing
[804] System Data Dump
[805] SMDR Account Code Selection
[806] SMDR Language Assignment
• Related Feature Reference
Language Selection
System Data Default Set
This system can re-initialise the system-programmed data. If all the programmed data is
cleared, the system will reset using the default settings by program [999].
• The default setting for each programming item is listed in Section 5.1, Default Values.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[999] System Data Clear
• Installation Reference
2.23 System Data Clear
3-64
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
S-T
System Speed Dialling
The system supports 100 System Speed Dial numbers (up to 32 digits) assigned in program
[001] that are available to all extension users. A System Speed Dial number is dialled out
using a simple operation.
Each System Speed Dial number can be assigned a name in program [011]. The assigned
name will be displayed when making a call by using the System Speed Dialling feature. It
will also be displayed when an external caller’s telephone number matches one of System
Speed Dialling numbers and the Telephone Company does not provide the caller’s name.
• Call Barring for System Speed Dialling can be assigned by program [301].
• A rotary telephone user cannot use this feature.
!
• Required System Programming
☞
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
[301] Call Barring – System Speed Dialling Boundary Class
• Related Feature
Call Barring for System Speed Dialling
• Operating Instructions for the Caller ID Card References
Section 1.2, System Features
Caller ID
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.3 Making Calls, “Dialling with System Speed Dialling (System Speed Dialling)”
Timed Reminder
<Timed Reminder>
Allows an extension user to generate an alarm tone at a preset time as a wake-up alarm or a
reminder. The user can set this to be activated once or everyday.
<Timed Reminder, Remote (Wake-Up Call)>
The operator or manager can remotely set, cancel and
confirm the Timed Reminder of the desired extension.
For example, this is useful for a small hotel or motel to
set an extension in a guest room as a wake-up call, or
set an extension in a child’s room by a mother.
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.7 Useful Features, “Alarm Setting (Timed
Reminder)”
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Timed Reminder, Remote (Wake-Up Call)”
Features
3-65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
T
Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service
The system supports the day, night and lunch operation modes. The system operation for
making and receiving calls can be different for the day, night and lunch modes. The system
operation for call barring can be arranged to prevent unauthorised toll calls for each mode.
Time service can be set automatically or manually by program [006].
Changing the Day/Night/Lunch Modes
The day, night and lunch modes can be changed either automatically at an assigned time in
program [007] or manually by the operator or manager at any desired time.
• The lunch mode interrupts the day or night mode. After the lunch mode is finished, the day
or night mode starts again.
• If the lunch mode is set using feature number “783#” in the automatic mode, the mode
can only be cancelled by using feature number “780#”. This can be useful during
holidays. The day and night modes are automatically changed at the programmed time in
[007] even if feature number “780#” is not entered. These operations can only be done
by an operator or manager.
!
• The operator and manager can see the status of the mode (day, night or lunch) by the pre-
assigned DSS buttons’ LED on the DSS console. Time service can be changed easily by
pressing the pre-assigned DSS buttons.
• The following programming items will be affected by the time service.
[405]-[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
[408]-[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
[411]-[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
[414]-[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
[601]-[603] Call Barring – Class of Service Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
[700]-[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
[703]-[705] Door Opener Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
• Required System Programming
☞
[006] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing Mode
[007] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time
• Operating Instructions References
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Setting”
1.9 DSS Console Features, “Initial Settings”, Day, Night and Lunch Buttons
Assignment
3-66
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
U
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
Distributes incoming calls to one specific extension group called a UCD group assigned in
program [520]. Calls to the UCD group hunt for an idle extension in numerical order. The
UCD feature is particularly helpful when a certain extension receives a high volume of calls
compared with other extensions.
• An optional OGM/FAX Detection Card is required to perform the UCD feature.
• The Log-In or Log-Out status can be set on an extension basis. There should be at least
one extension that is in Log -In status in the UCD group.
• An extension which sets the Call Forwarding–All, –Busy or No Answer, or the Do Not
Disturb (DND) feature is skipped during circular calling.
!
• When all extensions in the UCD group are busy, a busy message is heard and then Music
on Hold is activated. If any extension in the UCD group is not available within the
programmed time period, then (1) an OGM will be heard and the call is disconnected, or
(2) the call will be sent to pre-programmed extension(s) in [408]-[410]. System
Programming is required for this operation. Refer to the
and results for UCD calls”.
“Flow chart of possible cases
• Connection Reference
☞
2.15 OGM/FAX Detection Card Installation
• Required System Programming
[111] Hold Music Selection
[408]-[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment – Day/Night/Lunch
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
[502] OGM Mode Selection
[513] Cyclic Tone Detection
[520] UCD Group
[521] UCD Busy Waiting Time
[522] UCD OGM Message Interval Time
[523] UCD Busy Mode
[524] UCD Intercept Mode
[525] UCD Ringing Time before Intercept
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept
[600] Extension Group Assignment
• Related Feature References
Call Forwarding, Do Not Disturb (DND), Extension Group, Log-In/Log-Out
Features
3-67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
U
Outline of a UCD
(1) When a number of calls have arrived
(2) When the first call arrives at extension
A, the second call arrives at extension B.
at the UCD group, the first call arrives at
extension A first.
Calls have arrived at the UCD group.
3rd call in queue
2nd call in queue
3rd call in queue
2nd call in queue
1st call in queue
UCD group
Extension B
(When extension B is
busy or Log-Out has
been set at extension B,
the call arrives at exten-
sion C.)
UCD group
Extension A
(When extension A is
busy or Log-Out has
been set at extension A,
the call arrives at exten-
sion B.)
Extension C
-
Extension A
Extension B
(When extension B is
busy or Log-Out has
been set at extension B,
the call arrives at exten-
sion C.)
(3) When the second call arrives at
extension B, the third call will arrive at
extension C.
Extension C
(When extension C is
busy or Log-Out has
been set at extension C,
the call arrives at exten-
sion A.)
3-68
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
U
Flow chart of possible cases and results for UCD calls
An outside line call is made.
The caller reaches the UCD group.
Busy
Call
A
B
*1
OGM
Answered.
The call is not
answered.
*2
*4
Music on Hold is heard.
*9
Is Intercept Routing employed?
Busy
Call
*3
Yes
Goes to
Yes
B
Has the UCD Busy
Waiting Time expired?
No
C
*10
Disconnect.
No
The call is sent to
another extension.
*6
*5
What is the
OGM Mode?
Goes to
A
*11
MODE3 or MODE5
MODE4
MODE6
Answered.
The call is not
answered.
*7
*8
Is Intercept Routing
employed?
Is Intercept Routing
employed?
The other
OGM is heard.
*10
Disconnect.
Yes
Yes
No
No
Disconnect.
Disconnect.
Goes to
C
Busy tone
The other
OGM is heard.
Disconnect.
Goes to DISA
Note: The explanation for *1 through *11 is on the next page.
Features
3-69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
U
*1: An OGM is sent to the caller.
When the system detects a cyclic tone or CPC signal while the OGM is being sent, the call is
disconnected.
*2: Music on hold is selected in program [111] as follows.
• External – Uses an external music source, such as a radio.
• Tone – Uses the cyclic tone equipped with the system.
*3: When an extension in the UCD group is available.
*4: The system holds the call until the assigned time in program [521] expires.
*5: OGM repeats the assigned time intervals in program [522] within the assigned time in program
[521].
*6: The OGM Mode is selected in program [502].
*7: The system treats the call according to program [523] as follows when the assigned time in [521]
expires.
• Disconnect – The call is disconnected.
• Intercept – The call is sent to the extensions programmed in [408]-[410].
*8: The system treats the call according to program [523] as follows when the assigned time in [521]
expires.
• Disconnect – The call is disconnected.
• Intercept – The other OGM leads the caller to the DISA feature (☞ “Direct Inward System
Access (DISA)” in this section).
*9: The system treats the call according to program [524] as follows when the assigned time in [525]
expires.
• Disconnect – The call is disconnected.
• Intercept – The call is sent to the extensions programmed in [408]-[410].
*10: If the caller did not hear an OGM, the call will not be disconnected until the caller goes on-hook.
*11: The UCD Ring Timer after Intercept starts. The destination telephone(s) will ring for the time
programmed in program [526]. If the call is not answered during the programmed time, the call
will be disconnected.
3-70
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
V
Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100
This system supports Panasonic Voice Processing System (VPS) equipment (KX-TVP100)
by sending DTMF tones described in program [103]. The DTMF tones sent to a VPS
indicate the state of a call (busy, answered, ringing, disconnected, etc.). The DTMF tones
also inform a VPS of the destination of a call transferred to the VPS by the Call Forwarding
or DISA Intercept Routing – No Answer feature. Up to 4 VPSs can be connected to the
extension ports as extensions in the system.
System Explanation
1. Voice Mail Service
1.1 Call Forwarding to VM
If an extension user sets Call Forwarding (C. FWD) whose destination is the VPS, an
incoming call is forwarded to the VPS. The system sends the VPS the extension mailbox
number at that time. Therefore, the calling party can leave their message in the mailbox
of the desired extension without having to know the mailbox number.
Outside Call
DIL, DISA
System
Intercom
Call
KX-TVP100
C.FWD
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Extension
VM Hunting
Chain
Port 4
Outside Call
DIL, DISA
System
KX-TVP100
C.FWD
Port 1
Port 4
Port 2
Port 3
Operator
Extension
Transfer
VM Hunting
Chain
Features
3-71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
V
1.2 DISA Intercept to VM
If the VPS is set as the Intercept destination of an exchange line, an outside call is
forwarded to the VPS. The system sends the VPS the extension mailbox number at that
time. Therefore, the calling party can leave their message in the mailbox of the desired
extension without having to know the mailbox number. If a DISA call is transferred to
the VPS by Intercept Routing from a DISA ring group, your system will transmit the
mailbox number of the lowest port number of the DISA ring group. Delayed Ringing
must be assigned to VPS extensions in programs [411]-[413].
Outside Call
DISA
System
KX-TVP100
Intercept
Extension
Port 1
Port 2
Port 3
Port 4
1.3 Listening to a Recorded Message
If the VPS receives a message, the VPS can turn on the MESSAGE button indicator on
the corresponding proprietary telephone to notify to the user. The VPS notifies the
extension user that there is a message waiting in their mailbox. When the MESSAGE
button indicator is lit, pressing the button allows the extension user to play back the
stored message. A single line telephone user hears dial tone 3 (☞ “Distinctive Dial
Tones” in this section) when going off-hook if there are messages in their mailbox. They
can call the voice mail extension to listen to their messages. In this case, they must listen
to all of the messages. Once they access voice mail, dial tone 3 will be eliminated and not
be heard next time they go off-hook. Therefore, they will not know even if there are
messages left.
3-72
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
V
2. Automated Attendant (AA) Service
2.1 AA to Extension
AA receives and answers outside calls and offers services such as transferring to an
extension or mailbox using DTMF signalling, which is sent from the calling party.
Outside Call
DIL, UCD
System
KX-TVP100
Transfer
AA 1
AA 2
AA 3
Extension
AA Hunting Chain
or UCD Group
AA 4
• A VPS can be assigned as the destination for the following features.
Call Forwarding – All Calls
!
Call Forwarding – Busy/No Answer
DISA Intercept Routing – No Answer
In these functions, the caller does not need to know the mailbox number of the called
extension because the code is automatically transmitted to the VPS.
• The mailbox number is the same as its extension number.
• The Voice Mail extension should set Data Line Security to prevent interference from
system signals.
• If KX-TA624 cannot be selected with the PBX type setup menu of the KX-TVP100,
select “KX-T1232”. Follow the steps for a KX-T1232.
☞
• Connection Reference
2.8 Extension Connection
• Required System Programming
[009] Extension Number Assignment
[102] Voice Mail Port for KX-TVP100
[103] DTMF Integration for KX-TVP100
[408]-[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[411]-[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode — Day/Night/Lunch
[507] DISA Intercept Mode
• Related Feature References
Call Forwarding, Data Line Security, Direct Inward System Access (DISA),
Distinctive Dial Tones, Extension Hunting, Intercept Routing
• Operating Instructions Reference
1.7 Useful Features, “Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100”
Features
3-73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
3
Features
V-W
Volume Control
Allows a proprietary telephone user to adjust the following volumes, as necessary, by
adjusting the corresponding levers or pressing the corresponding buttons.
• Handset receiver volume
• Ringer volume
• Speaker volume
• Operating Instructions Reference
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Volume Control — Handset Receiver/
Ringer/Speaker”
Walking COS
Allows an extension user who is not at their own telephone to override the call barring COS
number of another extension by dialling their extension password. For the duration of the
call, the COS of the extension is changed to the COS of their own extension.
• If the extension overriding call barring is assigned to “Forced” or “Verify–All”, the user
must enter the account code before the line access code.
• When a user makes a call using this feature, the user’s extension number will be
displayed on the SMDR, not the extension where the user made the call.
!
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.7 Useful Features, “Calling Using Your Privileges at Another Extension
(Walking COS)”
1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Extension Password Set (Manager only)”
3-74
Features
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 4
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.1
Before System Programming
NOTE:
System data clear should be performed before System Programming.
(☞ 2.21, Starting the System for the First Time)
Default Setting
This system has factory default settings (☞ 5.1, Default Values). If any of the programming
needs to be changed, you can change the setting by System Programming. Default shows
you the factory default setting. Any required changes can be written in the Programming
Tables listed in section 7, Programming Tables.
Required Telephone Set
The following display proprietary telephone is required for System Programming.
• KX-T7130
Connect the telephone to the following.
• Port number 01
Before entering the programming mode
Before entering the programming mode, confirm that:
• Your telephone is on-hook.
• No calls are on hold at your telephone.
Placing the Overlay on a Telephone
A programming overlay is packed with the telephone at the factory. This overlay should be
used at all times during programming. The functions of the telephone keys change during
programming as shown below.
Location of Controls with the Overlay
SECRET
, –
CLEAR
PAUSE
STORE
2
5
8
3
6
9
1
4
7
AUTO
SELECT
0
PREV
FLASH
END
NEXT
KX-T7130
4-2
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.1
Before System Programming
To enter the programming mode
MEMORY
system password
#
SET
PROGRAM
Set to “PROGRAM” on
the back of the telephone.
Press #.
Enter the system password.
(default : 1234)
• The system password can be changed by program [002] “System Password”.
• During the programming mode, your extension is treated as a busy extension.
• If you enter the wrong system password, you will hear an alarm tone (3 beeps). Try
again.
!
Programming sequence
After entering the programming mode
X
X
X
STORE
parameters
END
Enter the Program Address. Enter the parameters. Press the
Press the END
STORE button. button.
After pressing the STORE button, you will hear one of the following tones.
Confirmation tone (1 beep):
This informs you that storing is completed. You can
continue programming by entering the same or another
program address
(2 beeps): This informs you that the same parameter has already been
stored.
Alarm tone (3 beeps):
This informs you that the entry is invalid.
To exit the programming mode
MEMORY
SET
PROGRAM
Set to “SET” on the back
of the telephone.
System Programming
4-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.1
Before System Programming
Programming example
The following programming instructions assume that you have already entered the
programming mode.
Example: Program [404] “Trunk Group Assignment”
Program address
Program title
[404] Trunk Group Assignment
Program
description
Assigns a maximum 6 trunk groups. Each exchange line must be assigned to an trunk
group. For example, if there are multiple telephone service companies available, exchange
lines can be grouped by company.
or PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
1
2
4
0
NEXT
4
exchange line no.*
trunk group no.*
END
(1···6)
(1···6/
)
To continue
SELECT
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
* Trunk (TRK) group number: 1 through 6
Program sequence:
1. Enter program address “404”.
2. Press “NEXT”.
2
Default
Exchange line 1 through 6 – Trunk group 1 through 6
3. Enter the exchange line number
(1 through 6) or press to
select all exchange lines.
4. Enter the trunk group number
(1 through 6).
• Each exchange line can only belong to one trunk group.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Outside Calling
5. Press “STORE”.
6. Press “END”.
Additional information
To continue assigning another
exchange line number, press
“SELECT” instead of “END”
and repeat from step 3.
You can also continue assigning
by pressing “PREV” or
“NEXT” instead of “END”.
You can go to the previous or
next exchange line and repeat
from step 4.
Provides the factory default setting. If you change the setting,
write the programmed data in the programming table listed in
section 7, Programming Tables.
Additional Information
• When you press , for example in step 3 in program [404], if all exchange lines have
been assigned as trunk group 1, “CO : TRK GRP – 1” will be displayed. If each
exchange line has been assigned to a different trunk group, “CO : Mixed” will be
displayed.
• You can press the SELECT button repeatedly to select the desired parameter, if available.
• You can use the
or
button to move to the next/previous step, if available.
4-4
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[000]-[001]
[000] Date and Time Setting
Sets the current date and time.
day
year
y
0
0
0
NEXT
SELECT
(00···99)
(Jan.···Dec.)
(1···31)
hour
minute
SELECT
END
SELECT
STORE
(Sun···Sat)
(1···12)
(00···59)
(AM/PM)
Default
’98 Jan. 1 Thu 12:00 AM
• To return to the previous programming step, press
.
!
• To correct a wrong entry for the year, day, hour or minute, press the CLEAR button and
enter the new one in each step.
• After changing an entry, you can press the STORE button. You do not have to perform
the rest of the steps.
• The clock starts immediately after the STORE button is pressed.
• The system supports years from 1998 to 2097.
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Date and Time Setting, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
Assigns a maximum of 100 System Speed Dialling numbers. To delete a stored phone
number, press the CLEAR and STORE buttons after entering the Speed Dialling number.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
phone no.
speed dialling no.
STORE
END
0
0
1
NEXT
(00···99)
32 digits max.
(e.g. 0···9,
)
To continue
SELECT
Default
Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• A line access number (9 or 0, 81 through 86) should be included before the phone
number.
System Programming
4-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[001]-[002]
4.2
System Programming
• Up to 32 digits, consisting of “0 through 9”, “ ,”, “#”, “PAUSE”, “—”,“RECALL” and
“ICM (Secret)”can be stored.
• If you are storing an account code assigned in [310] “Account Codes”, enter
account code after a line access number.
and the
• If you want to conceal all or part of a System Speed Dialling number on the display, enter
“[” and “]” (press the ICM button) before and after the part you want to conceal. Do not
press the ICM button before and after a line access number (9 or 0, 81 through 86) or an
account code. “[” and “]” are counted as one digit.
• Press
or
to scroll the display
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Secret Dialling, System Speed Dialling
[002] System Password
Assigns the password required for entering the System Programming mode. Also it is used
to set an extension password.
password
0
0
2
NEXT
STORE
END
4 digits
(0000···9999)
Default
1234
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Extension Password / System Password
4-6
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[003]-[004]
[003] DSS Console Port Assignment
Assigns a maximum of 2 port numbers to connect the DSS console(s).
DSS console no.
NEXT
extension port no.
0
0
3
STORE
END
(1···2)
(02···16)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
Default
All DSS consoles – Disable (Not stored)
• Two DSS consoles cannot be assigned to the same port number.
!
• Extension port 01 is the manager extension. So please do not assign extension port 01 as
the DSS console port.
• To not assign an extension port number, press the CLEAR button in the extension port
number step.
• The extension port number which has already been assigned as a paired telephone in program
[004] “Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS Console” is not available in this program.
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
DSS Console
☞
[004] Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS Console
Assigns a port number for an extension paired with the DSS console.
DSS console no.
NEXT
extension port no.
0
0
4
STORE
END
(1···2)
(01···16)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
Default
Extension port number paired with DSS console 1 – Disable (Not stored)
Extension port number paired with DSS console 2 – Disable (Not stored)
• A single line telephone (SLT) cannot be paired with the DSS console.
• To not assign an extension port number, press the CLEAR button in the extension port
number step.
• The extension port number which has already been assigned as a DSS console in program
[003] “DSS Console Port Assignment” is not available in this program.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
DSS Console
☞
System Programming
4-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[005]-[006]
4.2
System Programming
[005] One-Touch Transfer Using a DSS Button
Selects how an outside call is transferred to any extension using the DSS button.
With Transfer: Press the DSS button to transfer an outside call.
Without Transfer: Press the TRANSFER button then the DSS button to transfer an
outside call.
0
0
5
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(With Transfer/
Without Transfer)
Default
With Transfer
• This program is effective for 2 kinds of DSS buttons. One is on the DSS console, and the
other is flexible line key on your proprietary telephone assigned as a DSS button.
!
• Operating Instructions References
☞
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings, “Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
DSS (Direct Station Selection) Button
1.9 DSS Console Features, “Initial Settings”, One-Touch Dialling Assignment
[006] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing Mode
Selects changing the day, night and lunch service manually or automatically. For manual
changing, refer to the Operating Instructions. For automatic changing, set the next program
[007] “Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time”.
0
0
6
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Man/Auto)
Default
Manual
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service
4-8
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[007]-[008]
[007] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time
Sets the starting time on a week day basis, when “Automatic” is selected in program [006]
“Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing Mode”.
1
*
or
0
0
or
NEXT
PREV
7
NEXT
SELECT
(Every day)
(Day/Night/
(Sun···Sat)
Lunch-S/Lunch-E)
To go to another day of the week
To go to another mode
2
*
minute
STORE
END
SELECT
SELECT
hour or
(00···59)
(AM/PM)
(1···12)
<If you press the SELECT button>
1
* To assign every day of the week to one selection, press the
button.
2
* If the SELECT button is pressed, the display will show the previous entry. If the previous
setting was “None”, press the SELECT button to enter the starting time. If you do not
need to change the time service, keep pressing the SELECT button until “None” is
displayed. For example, if Monday’s day mode is set to “None”, the day mode will not be
turned on Monday.
Default
Everyday – Day – 9:00 AM / Night – 5:30 PM /
Lunch-S (starting) – None / Lunch-E (ending) – None
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service
[008] Operator Assignment
Assigns an extension port number for the operator.
extension port no.
0
0
NEXT
8
STORE
END
(01···24)
Default
Jack-01
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Operator / Manager Extension, Operator Call
System Programming
4-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[009]
4.2
System Programming
[009] Extension Number Assignment
Selects an extension numbering plan, Plan 1, Plan 2 or Plan 3, and assigns an extension
number to each extension.
Plan 1: Available extension numbers are 200 through 299.
Plan 2: Available extension numbers are 100 through 499.
Plan 3: Available extension numbers are 10 through 49.
0
0
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
9
(Plan:1/2/3)
NEXT or PREV
To continue
extension no.
extension port no.
NEXT
STORE
END
(01···24)
To continue
SELECT
Default
Plan 1: extension ports 01 through 24 – extension numbers 201 through 224
• If the selected extension numbering plan is the same as the previously stored one, 2 beeps
will be heard.
• If “Plan 2” or “Plan 3” is selected, the default extension numbers will change
automatically as follows.
!
Plan 2: extension ports 01 through 24 – extension numbers 201 through 224
Plan 3: extension ports 01 through 24 – extension numbers 21 through 44
• If “Plan 2” or “Plan 3” is selected, some feature numbers will also change. Refer to the
attached leaflet for details.
• A double entry of the extension number is invalid. If the programmed extension number
is the same as a previously stored one, 2 beeps will be heard when the STORE button is
pressed. When extension number 203 has already been assigned to port number 03, to
assign extension number 203 to the port number 05, change the extension number of port
number 03 to another one. Then assign extension number 203 to port number 05.
• If a Voice Processing System (VPS) is connected to the system, select “Plan 1” or “Plan
2” in this program and “Enable” in [103] “DTMF Integration”, so that the DTMF
integration between VPS and the system can be enabled.
• If a rotary telephone is used at any extension, select “Plan 1” in this program.
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Intercom Calling
☞
4-10
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[010]
[010] LCD Time Display Selection
Selects how the current time and date will be displayed on a proprietary telephone while idle.
Either 12 hour or 24 hour (military time) can be selected.
0
1
0
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(12/24 HOUR)
Display example:
When “12 HOUR” is selected: Jan 1 11:20PM
When “24 HOUR” is selected: 1 Jan 23:20
Default
12 HOUR
• Programs [000] “Date and Time Setting” and [007] “Time (Day/Night/ Lunch) Service
Start Time”, and the Timed Reminder feature are assigned using 12-hour time regardless of
this program. The SMDR printout is also printed using 12-hour time.
!
System Programming
4-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[011]
4.2
System Programming
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
Assigns a name to each System Speed Dialling number. The name will be displayed when
making a call by using the System Speed Dialling feature. It will also be used for the Caller
ID feature.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
speed dialling no.
name*
NEXT
END
0
1
1
16 characters
max.
(00···99)
To continue
SELECT
* Name:
Combination Table
Pressing SELECT
(Times)
Keys
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
Q
A
D
G
J
2
q
a
3
Z
B
E
H
K
N
R
U
X
,
4
z
5
!
6
?
c
f
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
b
e
C
F
I
d
g
j
h
k
n
r
i
L
O
S
V
Y
:
l
M
P
m
p
t
o
s
T
u
x
’
=
@
v
y
W
w
.
+
%
;
>
)
”
$
-
&
<
(
#
#
<Example>
— To enter “Mike;
1. Press 6 and then press the SELECT button once to enter “M”.
2. Press 4 and then press the SELECT button 6 times to enter “i”.
3. Press 5 and then press the SELECT button 4 times to enter “k”.
4. Press 3 and then press the SELECT button 4 times to enter “e”.
Default
All System Speed Dialling numbers – Not stored.
• To erase all letters, press the CLEAR button. To erase 1 letter, press
• Each name has a maximum of 16 characters.
.
!
• Press
to scroll the display to the right side.
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
System Speed Dialling
4-12
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[012]
[012] Alternative Feature Numbering Plan
Replaces any feature number with a code number 50 through 59. This is useful when
selecting “Plan 2” or “Plan 3” in program [009] “Extension Number Assignment” as some
feature numbers change for Plan 2 and Plan 3 and they might be difficult to remember.
(Refer to the attached leaflet “Notice for the Feature Numbers”.) All extension users can
dial these assigned codes instead of feature numbers.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
Feature no.
0
1
2
NEXT
code no.
END
10 digits max.
(0···9, , #)
(50···59)
To continue
SELECT
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• This is not possible when “Plan 1” has been selected in program [009].
!
System Programming
4-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[100]-[101]
4.2
System Programming
[100] Hunting Group Set
Enables or disables automatically locating an idle extension in the same extension group as
the dialled extension, when the called extension is busy. If “Enable” is selected, assign the
next program [101] “Hunting Type”. Extension groups are defined in program [600]
“Extension Group Assignment”.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
1
0
0
NEXT
extension group no.*
SELECT
STORE
END
(1···8/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension group number: 1 through 8 / (all extension groups)
Default All extension groups – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Extension Hunting
☞
[101] Hunting Type
Assigns the hunting type, Terminate or Circular, to each extension group when a hunting
group is enabled in program [100] “Hunting Group Set”.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
extension group no.*
END
1
0
1
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
(1···8/
)
(Terminate/
Circular)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension group number: 1 through 8 / (all extension groups)
Default All extension groups – Terminate
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Extension Hunting
☞
4-14
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[102]
[102] Voice Mail Port for KX-TVP100
Assigns the extension port number(s) connected to a Panasonic Voice Processing System
(VPS) equipment (KX-TVP100). Only extension ports 07, 08, 15 and 16 are available.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
SELECT
END
1
0
NEXT
2
(07,08,15,16/
)
(Enable/
Disable) To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 07, 08, 15 and/or 16 / (All 4 extension ports)
Default All 4 extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100
System Programming
4-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[103]
4.2
System Programming
[103] DTMF Integration for KX-TVP100
Enables or disables the system to send codes (DTMF signals) to the extension(s) assigned as
the Voice Mail Port in program [102] “Voice Mail Port”. These DTMF signals indicate the
state of the call (busy, answered, ringing, disconnected, etc.) in addition to the normal call
tones. They also enable the Panasonic Voice Processing System (VPS) equipment
(KX-TVP100) to immediately recognise the current state of the call and speed up the call
handling.
STORE
SELECT
NEXT
END
3
0
1
(Enable/Disable)
Default
Disable
• The table on next page describes the codes (DTMF signals), call state and conditions for
the DTMF integration operation.
• Select “Plan 1” or “Plan 2” in program [009] “Extension Number Assignment”, and select
“Enable” in this program to enable the DTMF integration.
!
• This feature greatly improves the performance of the Panasonic KX-TVP100: Voice
Processing Systems which have been programmed for Inband Signalling. For more
information about Inband Signalling, refer to your Voice Processing System manual.
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100
DTMF signals
Code
Call State
Ringback Tone
Busy Tone
Conditions
1
2
3
When an extension a VPS has dialled is ringing.
When an extension a VPS has dialled is busy.
Reorder Tone
When a VPS dials an invalid extension number or when a VPS
is accidentally connected to another Voice Mail Port.
4
DND
When an extension a VPS has dialled sets the DND (Do Not
Disturb) feature.
5
6
Answer
When an extension which a VPS has dialled answers the call.
When a called extension is forwarded to a VPS, the call can be
Forwarded to
Voice Processing forwarded to another available VPS. In this way, the first VPS,
System
(Ringing)
typically an Auto-Attendant, can release the call to another
VPS and receive another incoming call.
7
8
Forwarded to
Voice Mail (Busy) are available to receive the call.
When a called extension is forwarded to a VPS and no VPSs
Forwarded to
Extension
When a called extension is forwarded to another, non-VPS
extension.
9
Confirmation Tone When a VPS has successfully turned a message waiting lamp
on or a message waiting lamp off.
#9
Disconnect
When the calling party disconnects.
4-16
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[104]-[105]
[104] Hold Mode Selection
You can select how to hold a line and transfer a call to another extension with a single line
telephone (SLT), Hold-1, Hold-2 or Hold-3. If the following occurs frequently with an SLT,
select “Hold-2” or “Hold-3”.
• Nobody answers when a call is received.
• A busy tone is heard even though nobody is using the exchange line.
If a call is not terminated after going on-hook, the above cases occur. To avoid these
problems, select “Hold-2” or “Hold-3”. Every call will be terminated unless 50 is dialled
after pressing the Recall button in the Hold-2 and Hold-3 modes.
Hold-1: To hold a line or transfer a call, press the Recall button.
Hold-2: To hold a line, press the Recall button and dial 50. To transfer a call, press the
Recall button.
Hold-3: To hold a line or transfer a call, press the Recall button and dial 50.
1
0
4
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Hold-1/Hold-2
Hold-3)
Default
Hold-1
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Hold
[105] Conference Tone
Enables or disables the confirmation tone before starting or ending a conference call
established by the Conference feature or Executive Busy Override feature.
1
0
5
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Conference (3-party), Conference (5-party), Executive Busy Override
System Programming
4-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[106]-[108]
4.2
System Programming
[106] External Paging Access Tone
Enables or disables the splash tone before paging is sent over the external pager.
6
1
0
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Paging
[107] DTMF Receiver Check
Enables or disables the 6 DTMF receivers to check whether the DTMF receivers are
activated normally or not. Refer to the Section 6 Troubleshooting, “While Operating” for
further information on checking the DTMF receivers.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
DTMF receiver no.*
7
1
0
NEXT
SELECT
END
(Enable/
(1··6)
Disable)
* DTMF receiver number: 1 and 2 (for checking extension ports 01 through 08)/
3 and 4 (for checking extension ports 09 through 16)/
5 and 6 (for checking extension ports 17 through 24)
Default
All DTMF receivers – Enable
[108] Recall Mode for a Locked Extension
Enables or disables a locked extension to send a recall signal during a conversation with an
external party.
END
1
0
8
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Disable
4-18
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[109]-[110]
[109] CO Indicator Assignment
Enables or disables an extension which was assigned not to ring in programs [408]-[410]
“Flexible Ringing Assignment” to answer an incoming outside call. The line key indicator
will flash when an outside call is received. If enabled, an extension user can answer the call
by pressing the flashing line key. If disabled, the user cannot answer the call even if they
press the line key.
1
0
9
NEXT
SELECT STORE
END
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• The extension must be a proprietary telephone with a line key and indicator.
!
[110] Recall Key Mode
Assigns the sending of the recall signal mode, MODE 1 or MODE 2, when the RECALL
button on a proprietary telephone is pressed.
MODE 1: The recall signal is sent during the programmed time in [418] “Recall Time”.
MODE 2: The recall signal is sent while the RECALL button is pressed if the time the
RECALL button was pressed is more than the programmed time in [418].
This will be useful to disconnect the current call and make another call
without hanging up. If the time the RECALL button was pressed is less than
the programmed time in [418], the recall signal will be sent during the
programmed time.
1
0
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(MODE1/
MODE2)
Default
MODE 1
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Recall
☞
System Programming
4-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[111]-[112]
4.2
System Programming
[111] Hold Music Selection
Selects the music source, External or Tone, which an external party will hear when an
outside call is on hold.
External : Uses an external music source, such as a radio.
Tone : Uses the cyclic tone below equipped with the system.
1 s
1
1
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(External/Tone)
Default
External
• The music source can also be used for BGM.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Music on Hold / Background Music (BGM)
[112] DSS Console Indication Mode
Enables or disables the Busy Lamp Field (BLF) on the DSS button to indicate the status,
Forward (FWD) or Do Not Disturb (DND), of corresponding extensions.
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
1
2
(Enable/
Disable)*
* Enable: FWD – Flashing slowly, DND – Flashing moderately
Disable: FWD – Off, DND – Off
Default
Enable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
DSS Console
☞
4-20
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[115]-[116]
[115] Extension Ringing Pattern Selection
Selects the extension ringing pattern when an intercom call received, either Single, Double
or Triple.
1 s
Single:
Double:
Triple:
1
5
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Single/Double/
Triple)
Default
Single
• The length of the ring cycle for a single line telephone (SLT) is determined in program
[124] “SLT Ringing Mode Selection”.
• The extension ringback pattern is determined at the same time.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Ringing Pattern Selection
[116] Conference Pattern Selection
Selects the maximum number of external parties which can attend a conference. The
maximum number of conference parties is 5.
3-party C-0 E-3: No external parties can attend a 3-party conference.
3-party C-1 E-3: One external party can attend a 3-party conference.
3-party C-2 E-3: A maximum of 2 external parties can attend a 3-party conference.
5-party C-2 E-5: A maximum of 2 external parties can attend a 5-party conference.
1
1
6
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(3-party C-0 E-3/
3-party C-1 E-3/
3-party C-2 E-3/
5-party C-2 E-5)
Default
5-party C-2 E-5
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Conference (3-Party), Conference (5-Party)
System Programming
4-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[117]-[119]
4.2
System Programming
[117] Call Pickup Tone
Enables or disables the confirmation tone when the Call Pickup feature is activated.
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
1
7
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Pickup
☞
[118] Pulse Restriction
Enables or disables sending pulse dialling to the Local Exchange during a conversation with
an external party when “Pulse Mode” or “Call Block Mode” is selected in program [401]
“Dial Mode”.
1
1
8
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
[119] Redialling after Pulse to Tone Conversion
Enables or disables sending tone dialling to the Local Exchange when an extension user
redials after changing the pulse mode into tone mode by pressing and #.
1
1
9
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Pulse to Tone Conversion
4-22
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[120]-[122]
[120] Bell Frequency
Selects the bell frequency sent to a single line telephone (SLT).
2
0
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(20/25 Hz)
Default
25 Hz
[121] Automatic Exchange Line Access Number Selection
Selects the Automatic Exchange Line Access number ( 0 or 9).
1
2
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Dial 0/Dial 9)
Default
Dial 9
• If you select “0”, the operator call will automatically be “9”. If you select “9”, the
operator call will automatically be “0”
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number, Operator Call
[122] Automatic Rotation for Exchange Line Access
Enables or disables the rotation of exchange lines seized for “Automatic Exchange Line
Access”.
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
2
2
(Enable
Disable)
Default
Disable (Does not rotate.)
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number
System Programming
4-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[123]-[125]
4.2
System Programming
[123] Break Ratio
Selects the pulse break rate, MODE1 or MODE 2, when a Pulse is sent to the Local
Exchange during a conversation.
MODE 1: 66 %
MODE 2: 60 %
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
2
3
(MODE1/
MODE2)
Default
MODE 1
[124] SLT Ringing Mode Selection
Selects the length of the ring cycle for a single line telephone (SLT).
MODE 1: 5 second cycle
MODE 2: 3 second cycle
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
2
4
(MODE1/
MODE2)
Default
MODE 2
[125] Call Barring Check for
and #
Assigns whether the entered “ ” and “#” are checked by call barring or not. This
assignment is required for certain Local Exchanges to prevent toll fraud. Some Central
Offices ignore the user-dialled “ ” and “#”. If your Local Exchange ignores these symbols,
select “Disable”.
.
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
2
5
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
4-24
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[126]-[127]
[126] DSS Off-Hook Mode
Enables or disables making an intercom call just by pressing a DSS button on a DSS
Console. If enabled, going off-hook is not needed.
.
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
6
2
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable
• This assignment is also effective for a flexible line key on a proprietary telephone
assigned as a DSS button.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Intercom Calling
[127] Pickup Group Set
Enables or disables the ability of an extension to pickup a call ringing at another extension
(if it is in the same extension group) by just going off-hook. If enabled, the feature number
(40) is not needed to pickup the call.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
2
7
1
NEXT
extension group no.*
SELECT
STORE
END
(1···8/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension group number: 1 through 8 / (all extension groups)
Default
All extension groups – Disable (the feature number (40) is required to pickup
the call)
• To prevent other extensions in the same extension group from picking up outside calls by
just going off-hook, select “Disable” in program [109] “CO Indicator Assignment”. Then
even though “Enable” is selected in this program [127], outside calls cannot be picked up
by others by just going off-hook.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Pickup
☞
System Programming
4-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[200]-[201]
4.2
System Programming
[200] Hold Recall Time
Assigns the length of the hold recall timer. Hold recall (a ring tone or an alarm tone) is
heard when the timer expires. If hold recall is not required, select “Disable”.
NEXT
0
0
2
SELECT
STORE
END
(30 sec/
1/1.5/2/3/4/5/6 min/
Disable)
Default
30 seconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Call Park, Hold
☞
[201] Transfer Recall Time
Assigns the length of the transfer recall timer. If a transferred call is not answered within the
programmed time, the call will be returned to the original caller.
2
0
1
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(15/30 sec/
1/2 min)
Default
30 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Call Transfer – to Extension
4-26
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[202]-[203]
[202] Call Forwarding Start Time
Assigns time for the Call Forwarding – No Answer feature. If a call is not answered within
the programmed time, the call will be forwarded to the destination.
2
0
2
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(5/10/15/20
sec delay)
Default
15 seconds delay
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Forwarding
☞
[203] Pickup Dial Delay Time
Assigns the length of time for the Pickup Dialling feature. If the telephone user lifts the
handset, the programmed party is called automatically when the timer expires. This delay
gives the user an opportunity to enter numbers before automatic dialling occurs.
STORE
2
0
3
NEXT
SELECT
END
(1/2/3/4 sec)
Default
3 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Pickup Dialling
☞
System Programming
4-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[204], [206]
4.2
System Programming
[204] Call Duration Count Start Time
Assigns the start time of a conversation either immediately after an exchange line is seized
or after dialling. This corresponds to the length of the conversation displayed on the LCD
and printed on the printer (SMDR).
2
0
4
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(5/10/15/20/25/30/
35/40/45/50 sec after
dial/Instantly)
Default
10 seconds after dialling
• If reverse signal detection is enabled in program [424] “Reverse (Polarity) Circuit
Assignment”, the system will automatically start the timer immediately after an external
party answers a call.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Polarity Reverse Detection, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
[206] Dialling Start Time
Assigns the minimum length of the pause time the system waits before dialling after seizing
an exchange line.
2
0
6
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(0/250/500/750/
1000/1250/1500 ms)
Default
0 millisecond
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Outside Calling
☞
4-28
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[207]-[208]
[207] Recall Timing Range Selection
Sets the hookswitch recall time range sent from an extension to the system.
MODE 1: 50 to 180 milliseconds.
MODE 2: 80 to 180 milliseconds.
MODE 3: 80 to 650 milliseconds.
MODE 4: 80 to 1000 milliseconds.
MODE 5: 200 to 1000 milliseconds.
2
0
NEXT
STORE
7
SELECT
END
(MODE1/MODE2/
MODE3/MODE4/
MODE5)
Default
MODE 1
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Recall Button on a Single Line Telephone
[208] Interdigit Time
Assigns the maximum time allowed between digits for an outgoing outside call.
2
0
8
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(5/10/15/20 sec)
Default
20 seconds
• The interdigit timer applies until the call barring check is completed. When the timer
expires, an outgoing outside call will be disconnected while dialling, if “Enable” was
selected in program [211] “No Dial Disconnection”.
• For a single line telephone, an outgoing outside call will be released from a DTMF
receiver when the interdigit timer expires.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
System Programming
4-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[210]-[211]
4.2
System Programming
[210] DTMF Time
Assigns the minimum duration of a DTMF signal sent to an exchange line which is set to the
DTMF mode in program [401] “Dial Mode”.
MODE 1: 80 milliseconds
MODE 2: 160 milliseconds
2
1
0
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
END
(MODE1/
MODE2)
Default
MODE 1
[211] No Dial Disconnection
Enables or disables disconnecting an exchange line if an extension user does not dial
anything within 20 seconds after an exchange line is seized.
END
2
1
NEXT
STORE
1
SELECT
(Enable/
Disable)
Default
Enable (Disconnect)
• The interdigit timer assigned in program [208] “Interdigit Time” applies until the call
barring check is completed. When the timer expires, an outgoing outside call will be
disconnected while dialling, if “Enable” was selected in this program.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
4-30
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[212]-[213]
[212] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit
Sets the maximum time allowed for a conversation with an external party. This program is
effective for the extension(s) which assigned “Enable” in program [613] “Exchange Line
Duration Time Limit Selection”.
time
2
1
2
NEXT
STORE
END
(1··32 minutes)
Default
10 minutes
• A beep sounds at 5-second intervals 15 seconds before the programmed time expires.
• This program is effective only for an outgoing outside call.
• When making a call after an exchange line is seized and transferred to the enabled
extension in program [613] by another extension, the timer starts after the call has been
transferred.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Limited Call Duration
[213] Bell Off Detection
Sets the maximum time between detecting one bell signal and the next from the Local
Exchange. In case the next bell signal is not detected within the programmed time, the
system recognises the bell signal has stopped.
END
2
1
3
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
(3/6/12 sec)
Default
3 seconds
System Programming
4-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[300]-[301]
4.2
System Programming
[300] Carrier Excepted Code Assignment
Assigns up to 20 carrier excepted codes, for example, Per Call Block code ( 141). The
system disregards the assigned code, and call barring and ARS are applied to the numbers
after the code.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
code no.
code
3
0
0
NEXT
END
10 digits max.
(0···9, ,#)
(01···20)
To continue
SELECT
Example:
Code no. 01:
Dialling number:
disregarded
141
141 01633 877 467
applied to the call barring and ARS
All codes – Not stored.
Default
• “x” (press the PAUSE button) substitutes any number (= wild card).
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
[301] Call Barring – System Speed Dialling Boundary Class
Assigns the call barring class for System Speed Dialling numbers. System Speed Dialling
numbers can be assigned in program [001] “System Speed Dialling Entry”.
3
0
1
NEXT
STORE
END
SELECT
(Class-1···5)*
* Boundary Class: 1 through 5
Default Boundary Class -1
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Call Barring for System Speed Dialling
4-32
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[302]-[305]
[302]-[305] Call Barring – Classes 2 through 5 Denied Codes
Assigns up to 20 toll call numbers which are restricted to make outside calls on a class of
service (COS) basis for each program.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
code no.
phone no.
END
STORE
3
0
NEXT
X
11 digits
(01···20)
(0···9, ,#)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 2 ([302] for Class 2) / 3 ([303] for Class 3)/
4 ([304] for Class 4) / 5 ([305] for Class 5)
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• “x” (press the PAUSE button) substitutes any number (= wild card).
• Each phone number should consist of 11 digits.
!
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
System Programming
4-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[306], [309]
4.2
System Programming
[306] Call Barring – Exception Codes
Assigns up to 80 exception numbers which are allowed to make outside calls on a class of
service (COS) basis even when denied codes are programmed in [302]-[305] “Call Barring
– Classes 2 through 5 Denied Codes”.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
code no.
phone no.
11 digits
STORE
3
0
6
NEXT
END
(01···80)
(0···9, ,#)
To continue
SELECT
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• “x” (press the PAUSE button) substitutes any number (= wild card).
• Each phone number should consist of 11 digits.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
[309] Emergency Dial Number Set
Assigns up to 5 emergency numbers, for example, a police station or fire station. Calls with
these numbers are free from restrictions, for example, call barring, Account Code –
Forced/Verify–All mode and Electronic Extension Lock.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
emergency no.
code no.
3
0
9
NEXT
END
11 digits max.
(0···9)
(1···5)
To continue
SELECT
Default
Code-01 = 999, Code-02 = 112, Other codes = Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
☞
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Emergency Call, Call Barring
4-34
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[310]-[311]
[310] Account Codes
Assigns up to 24 account codes which are compared with the code entered when
“Verify-All” or “Verify-Toll (Call Barring)” is selected in program [605] “Account Code
Entry Mode”. If “Verify-All” is selected, an account code is required to make an outside
call. If “Verify-Toll (Call Barring)” is selected, an account code is only required to override
call barring.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
account code
3
1
0
NEXT
code no.
END
4 digits
(0···9)
(01···24)
To continue
SELECT
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Account Code Entry, Call Barring Override by Account Codes
[311] Automatic Pause Insertion Codes
Assigns up to 40 automatic pause insertion codes which are checked with the outside
outgoing call number. When one of the codes is the same as the call number, the pause time
assigned in program [417] “Pause Time” is automatically inserted after the code. If a second
dial tone is sent from your Local Exchange, it is convenient to assign the area code as the
pause code.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
code no.
pause code
3
1
1
NEXT
END
7 digits max.
(0···9, ,#)
(01···40)
To continue
SELECT
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
System Programming
4-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[312]
4.2
System Programming
[312] Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class
Assigns the Call Barring class for an extension which has set the Electronic Extension
Lockout or Remote Extension Lock Control.
3
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
1
2
(Disable/
COS-2···5)*
* Boundary COS: 2 through 5 / Disable (Disables all outside outgoing calls.)
Default Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class
4-36
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[350]-[354]
[350] ARS Selection
Enables or disables the ARS feature for each exchange line.
NEXT or
PREV
To continue
exchange line no.*
3
5
0
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(1···6/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
[351]-[354] Routes 1 through 4 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
Assigns up to 80 area codes for outside calls which are applied to the ARS feature for each
route.
or
NEXT
PREV
To continue
code no.
area code
END
STORE
5
3
NEXT
X
7 digits max.
(0···9, ,#)
(01···80)
(1···4)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 1 ([351] for Route 1) / 2 ([352] for Route 2)/
3 ([353] for Route 3) / 4 ([354] for Route 4)
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• “x” (press the PAUSE button) substitutes any number (= wild card).
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
System Programming
4-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[355]-[359]
4.2
System Programming
[355]-[358] Routes 1 through 4 Exception Codes
Assigns up to 80 area codes for outside calls which are not applied to the ARS feature for
each route.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
code no.
area code
END
STORE
3
5
NEXT
X
7 digits max.
(0···9, ,#)
(01···80)
(5···8)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 5 ([355] for Route 1) / 6 ([356] for Route 2)/
7 ([357] for Route 3) / 8 ([358] for Route 4)
Default
All codes – Not stored.
• “x” (press the PAUSE button) substitutes any number (= wild card).
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
[359] 1st Carrier Selection Code (BT Line Access Code)
Assigns the first carrier access code. When the code is dialled, the first carrier is always
selected even if the ARS feature is enabled.
1st carrier access code
END
STORE
3
5
9
NEXT
4 digits max.
(0···9)
Default
121 (British Telecom Line access code)
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
4-38
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[360]-[361]
[360] ARS Modification – Removed Digits
Determines how the dialled number applied to the ARS feature should be modified before
sending to the exchange line for each route. The digits are deleted from the beginning of the
dialled number.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
route no.
removed digits
END
STORE
3
6
0
NEXT
(1···4)
(0···9)
To continue
SELECT
Default
All routes – 0 (No deletion)
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
[361] ARS Modification – Added Number
Determines how the dialled number applied to the ARS feature should be modified before
sending to the exchange line for each route. Numbers are added to the beginning of the
dialled number. Numbers can be carrier codes, etc.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
route no.
added number
20 digits max.
(0···9, ,#)
END
STORE
3
6
NEXT
1
(1···4)
To continue
SELECT
Default
Route 1 = 131, Other routes = Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
• Press to scroll the display to the right side.
• The assigned numbers will be added to the dialled number after deleting the digits
programmed in [360] “ARS Modification — Removed Digits”.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
System Programming
4-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[362]-[363]
4.2
System Programming
[362] ARS Dial Tone Pattern Selection
Selects the dial tone pattern, Disable (no tone), Tone1, Tone2 or Tone3, generated after
seizing an ARS exchange line. The ARS feature is enabled on an exchange line basis in
program [350] “ARS Selection”. The tone will stop after the first digit (except for an
account code) is dialled.
1 s
Tone1:
Tone2:
Tone3:
6
2
STORE
END
3
NEXT
SELECT
(Disable/Tone1/
Tone2/Tone3)
Default
Tone1
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
[363] ARS Interdigit Time
Assigns the interdigit timer (in seconds) used while the system is checking the dialled
number for the ARS feature.
time
6
STORE
END
3
3
NEXT
(1···20)
Default
5 seconds
• This assignment should be the same as the interdigit timer assigned in program [208]
“Interdigit Time”.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
4-40
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[364]
[364] ARS Trunk Group
Assigns trunk group(s) for each ARS route number. Trunk groups are assigned in program
[404] “Trunk Group Assignment”. An exchange line in the assigned trunk group(s) is
automatically seized when making an outside call using the Automatic Exchange Line
Access number (9 or 0), and the dialled number is applied to one of the ARS route numbers.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
3
6
4
NEXT
route no.
trunk group no.*
STORE
END
(1···4)
(1···6/
)
To continue
SELECT
* Trunk (TRK) group number: 1 through 6 /
(All trunk (TRK) groups)
Default All routes – (All trunk (TRK) groups)
• Programs [351]-[354] “Routes 1 through 4 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)” should be
considered when assigning this program.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
System Programming
4-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[381]-[384]
4.2
System Programming
[381]-[384] Routes 1 through 4 Authorisation Codes
Registers an authorisation code applied to the exchange line(s).
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
authorisation code
exchange line no.*
END
STORE
3
8
NEXT
X
19 digits max.
(0···9)
(1···6/
)
(1···4)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 1 ([351] for Route 1) / 2 ([352] for Route 2)/
3 ([353] for Route 3) / 4 ([354] for Route 4)
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default
All exchange lines – Not stored.
• The registered codes are not shown on the display of a proprietary telephone and printout
by program [804] “System Data Damp” after programming. “Already Set” will be shown
instead of the registered codes.
!
4-42
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[385]-[389]
[385]-[388] Routes 1 through 4 Itemised Bill
Enables or disables to add an extension number assigned in program [389] “Itemised Bill
Code Assignment” after the authorisation code for an exchange line(s). This is useful for
billing purposes.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
END
8
SELECT
3
NEXT
X
(1···6/
)
(Enable/
(5···8)
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 5 ([385] for Route 1) / 2 ([386] for Route 2)/
3 ([387] for Route 3) / 4 ([388] for Route 4)
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default
All exchange lines – Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
[389] Itemised Bill Code Assignment
Assigns the itemised bill code for each extension for dividing a bill.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
itemised bill code.
extension port no.
3
8
9
NEXT
END
3 digits max.
(0···9)
(01···24/
)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 16 / (All extension ports)
Default Extension ports 01 through 24 – 201 through 224
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Automatic Route Selection (ARS)
System Programming
4-43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[400]-[401]
4.2
System Programming
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment
Assigns which exchange line(s) is connected to the system or not.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
4
0
0
NEXT
SELECT
END
(1···6/
)
(Connect/
Not connect)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Connect
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Outside Calling
☞
[401] Dial Mode
Selects the dialling mode, DTMF, Pulse or C. BLK (Call Blocking), for each exchange line.
DTMF: The dialling signals from an extension, either Tone or Pulse, are converted to
Tone and transmitted to the Local Exchange. If the system is connected directly
to the Local Exchange or installed behind a host PBX, which receives both Tone
and Pulse, select this mode.
Pulse : The dialling signals from an extension, either Tone or Pulse, are converted to
Pulse and transmitted to the Local Exchange.
C. BLK: If your Local Exchange can receive both DTMF and Pulse signals but the user
are contracted for Pulse, select this mode. When dialling with a touch tone
telephone, only Pulse signals are sent to the Local Exchange.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
4
0
1
NEXT
exchange line no.*
END
SELECT
(1···6/
)
(DTMF/Pulse/
C.BLK Mode)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – DTMF Mode
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Pulse to Tone Conversion
4-44
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[402]-[403]
[402] Pulse Speed Selection
Selects a pulse rate for each exchange line which sets “Pulse Mode” or “Call block Mode” in
program [401] “Dial Mode”. There are 2 pulse rates, Low Speed (10 pps) and High Speed
(20 pps).
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
SELECT
END
4
0
2
NEXT
(1···6/
)
(Low/High
To continue
Speed)
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Low Speed
[403] Host PBX Access Codes
If the system is installed behind a host PBX, each exchange line may require an access code
to make an outside call. Up to 8 access codes can be stored for each exchange line. When
the programmed codes are dialled, the pause time assigned in program [417] “Pause Time”
is automatically inserted, and call barring is applied after the code.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
1
2
4
0
3
NEXT
exchange line no.* access code*
END
Up to 8 access codes
1 or 2 digits
(0···9)
(1···6/
)
To continue
SELECT
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
2
,
* Insert a “,” for each code using the
button on the overlay.
Example:
• Access codes 81, 82 on exchange line number 1
0
NEXT
STORE
END
4
3
1
8
1
8
2
,
Default
All exchange lines – Not stored
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Host PBX Access
☞
System Programming
4-45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[404]
4.2
System Programming
[404] Trunk Group Assignment
Assigns a maximum 6 trunk groups. Each exchange line must be assigned to an trunk
group. For example, if there are multiple telephone service companies available, exchange
lines can be grouped by company.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
1
2
4
0
NEXT
4
exchange line no.*
trunk group no.*
END
(1···6)
(1···6/
)
To continue
SELECT
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
2
* Trunk (TRK) group number: 1 through 6
Default
Exchange line 1 through 6 – Trunk group 1 through 6
• Each exchange line can only belong to one trunk group.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Outside Calling
4-46
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[405]-[407]
[405]-[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch
Determines which extension(s) can make an outside call in the day, night and/or lunch modes.
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
Go to next or prev. line number
or
To continue
Go to next or prev.
port number
1
2
4
exchange line no.*
(1···6/
X
(05···07)
NEXT
extension port no.*
STORE
SELECT
END
#
)
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
Go to another port number
To continue
Go to another line number
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 05 ([405] for day) / 06 ([406] for night) /
07 ([407] for lunch)
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
2
Default
All exchange lines – all extension ports – Enable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Outside Calling
☞
System Programming
4-47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[408]-[410]
4.2
System Programming
[408]-[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch
Determines which extension(s) will ring for incoming outside calls in the day, night and/or
lunch modes.
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
Go to next or prev. line number
or
To continue
Go to next or prev.
port number
1
2
4
exchange line no.*
(1···6/
X
NEXT
extension port no.*
STORE
SELECT
END
#
)
(08···10)
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
Go to another port number
To continue
SELECT
Go to another line number
X – Program address selection number: 08 ([408] for day) / 09 ([409] for night) /
10 ([410] for lunch)
(All exchange lines)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6
2
Default All exchange lines – all extension ports – Enable
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Exchange Line Ringing Selection, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD),
Receiving Calls
4-48
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[411]-[413]
[411]-[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch
Assigns the ringing start time for extension(s) which were selected to ring in programs
[408]-[410] “Flexible Ringing Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch” in the day, night and/or lunch
modes.
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
Go to next or prev. line number
or
To continue
Go to next or prev.
port number
1
2
4
exchange line no.*
(1···6/
X
(11···13
NEXT
extension port no.*
STORE
SELECT
END
#
)
)
(01···24/
)
(Immdtly/
10/20/30 sec)
To continue
Go to another port number
To continue
Go to another line number
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 11 ([411] for day) / 12 ([412] for night)/
13 ([413] for lunch)
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
2
Default
All exchange lines – all extension ports – Immediately
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Receiving Calls
☞
System Programming
4-49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[414]-[416]
4.2
System Programming
[414]-[416] Exchange Line Mode —Day/Night/Lunch
Selects the mode of an incoming outside call on each exchange Line in the day, night and
lunch modes. There are the following 5 modes.
Normal: An incoming outside call will be received at the extension(s) assigned in
programs [408]–[410] “Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch”.
DIL:
An incoming outside call will be received at the assigned extension in this
program.
DISA1: An incoming outside call will be received at an extension through the DISA
feature. A caller will hear a tone or an outgoing message.
DISA2: An incoming outside call will be received at an extension through the DISA
feature. A caller might hear OGM 2; for various configurations please see Cases
2, 3 and 4 in Section 3, Features “Outgoing Message (OGM).
UCD: An incoming outside call will be received at an extension through the UCD
feature.
< To select Normal,
DISA or UCD >
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
1
exchange line no.*
4
NEXT
X
END
SELECT
(1···6/
)
(14···16)
(Normal/DIL/
DISA1/DISA2/
UCD)
To continue
SELECT
< To select DIL >
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
1
2
4
exchange line no.*
(1···6/
X
NEXT
extension port no.*
SELECT
END
STORE
)
(14···16)
(01···24/
)
(Normal/DIL/
DISA1/DISA2/
UCD)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 14 ([414] for day) / 15 ([415] for night)/
16 ([416] for lunch)
* Exchange Line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
2
Default
All exchange lines – Normal
4-50
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[414]-[417]
• You must select “DISA1”when the optional OGM/FAX Detection card is not installed and
if you want to use the internal DISA.
• When you select “UCD”, assign program [520] “UCD Group” to determine which
extension group is assigned to the UCD group.
!
• When you select “DISA1”, “DISA2” and/or “UCD”, assign program [502] “OGM Mode
Selection” to determine which OGM will be used.
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct In Line (DIL), Direct Inward System Access (DISA),
Outgoing Message (OGM), Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
[417] Pause Time
Assigns the length of the pause time. The programmed pause time is automatically inserted
after a line access code, a host PBX access code programmed in [403] “Host PBX Access
Codes” or a pause code assigned in [311] “Automatic Pause Insertion Codes” or can be
manually inserted by the user using the PAUSE button.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
4
END
1
7
NEXT
exchange line no.*
SELECT
STORE
(1.5/2.5/
3.5/4.5 sec)
(1···6/
)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – 1.5 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Host PBX Access
☞
System Programming
4-51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[418]-[419]
4.2
System Programming
[418] Recall Time
Assigns the length of the recall time. If your system is installed behind a host PBX, External
Feature Access is necessary to obtain its services. To enable it, select the required recall
signal sending time for an exchange line.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
4
1
8
NEXT
END
SELECT
(1···6/
)
(80/100/160/
300/600/900/
1200 ms)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – 100 milliseconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
External Feature Access, Recall
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access
Selects which exchange line can be seized automatically when an extension user dials the
Automatic Line Access number (0 or 9) assigned in program [121] “Automatic Exchange
Line Access Number Selection”.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
4
NEXT
exchange line no.*
1
9
SELECT
END
( 1···6/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Enable
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Automatic Exchange Line Access Number, Outside Calling
4-52
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[420]
[420] Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal
Assigns the required minimum duration of the Calling Party Control (CPC) signal from the
Local Exchange for incoming outside calls. If programmed, the system disconnects the line
when the CPC signal is detected.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
4
2
0
NEXT
exchange line no.*
X
END
(1···6/
)
(00···75
)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
X – CPC signal detect time selection number: No. = selection number
Detect time (milliseconds)
No. Detect time
No. Detect time
No. Detect time
No. Detect time
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Disable
22
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
166
174
182
190
198
206
214
222
230
238
246
254
262
270
278
286
294
302
310
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
318
326
334
342
350
358
366
374
382
390
398
406
414
422
430
438
446
454
462
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
470
478
486
494
502
510
518
526
534
542
550
558
566
574
582
590
598
606
614
30
38
46
54
62
70
78
86
94
102
110
118
126
134
142
150
158
Default
All exchange lines – Disable (No. 00)
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection
System Programming
4-53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[421]-[422]
4.2
System Programming
[421] CPC Detection for Outgoing Calls
Enables or disables the CPC signal detection during an outgoing outside call. If disabled,
the CPC signal detection is only activated during an incoming outside call or after call hold.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
4
2
1
NEXT
exchange line no.*
END
SELECT
(1···6/
)
(Enable/
Disable) To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal Detection
[422] Disconnect Time
Determines the amount of time to send the disconnect signal from the system to the Local
Exchange or host PBX. The time you select must be longer than the requirement of your
Local Exchange or host PBX.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
4
NEXT
SELECT
END
2
2
(1···6/
)
(0.5/2.0/
4.0 sec)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – 2.0 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Recall
☞
4-54
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[423]
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection
Selects the incoming outside call ringing pattern, Single, Double or Triple, for each
exchange line. This is useful for distinguishing private calls from business calls.
1 s
Single:
Double:
Triple:
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
4
3
NEXT
SELECT
END
2
(1···6/
)
(Single/Double/
Triple)
To continue
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Double
• When selecting the ring pattern illustrated above, we recommend that other ring patterns of
the system be considered. Namely, please consider the settings of [115] “Extension Ringing
Pattern Selection” and [706] “Doorphone Ringing/Tone Pattern Selection”.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Ringing Pattern Selection
System Programming
4-55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[424]
4.2
System Programming
[424] Reverse (Polarity) Circuit Assignment
Enables or disables detecting the reverse signal for each exchange line’s polarity from the
Local Exchange when making a call. If enabled, the outside call duration can be
determined.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
exchange line no.*
NEXT
4
2
4
SELECT
STORE
END
(1···6/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Polarity Reverse Detection
4-56
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[500]
[500] DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection
Selects the destination of an incoming outside call via the DISA feature when you select
“DISA 1” or “DISA 2” in programs [414]-[416] “Exchange Line Mode –Day/Night/Lunch”,
Without AA (auto attendant) or With AA . If you select “With AA”, assign the next
program [501] “DISA Built-in Auto Attendant”.
Without AA: Available destinations are: extension numbers assigned in program
[009] “Extension Number Assignment” and the operator number (0 or 9).
With AA:
Available destinations are: numbers available in the “Without AA” mode,
and numbers (0 through 9) assigned in program [501].
5
0
0
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(Without AA/
With AA)
Default
Without AA
• For example: in the “With AA” mode, if a number is not dialled within the programmed
time in [517] “DISA AA Wait Time” after dialling 1, the call is received at the DISA
built-in auto attendant number 1.
!
• In the “With AA” mode, if 0 or 9 is not assigned in program [501], the system recognises
them as a the operator number.
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
System Programming
4-57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[501]
4.2
System Programming
[501] DISA Built-in Auto Attendant
Assigns a maximum of 10 DISA built-in auto attendant numbers when “With AA” is
selected in program [500] “DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection”. The extension
numbers assigned in program [009] “Extension Number Assignment”, and the extension
group numbers assigned in program [600] “Extension Group Assignment” can be assigned as
a 1 digit number and used as DISA built-in auto attendant numbers.
extension
port no.
(01···24)
extension
group no.
(1···8)
AA no.
5
0
1
NEXT
SELECT
or
(0···9)
(Jack/GRP/
Not Stored)
To continue
or
PREV
STORE
END
NEXT
Default
All auto attendant numbers – Not stored
• If you would like to use the operator number in the “With AA” mode, do not assign auto
attendant number(s) which correspond to the operator number (0 or 9).
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
4-58
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[502]
[502] OGM Mode Selection
Selects how the 2 outgoing messages (OGM1 and OGM2) are used, MODE1 through
MODE6.
Mode OGM1 OGM2
Description
1
2
3
4
DISA1 DISA1 The system can receive 2 incoming calls via the DISA feature
at the same time. This is useful when receiving many calls.
DISA1 DISA2 An example: DISA1 is used in the day mode and DISA2 is
used in the night mode.
UCD
UCD
The system can hold up to 2 incoming calls via the UCD
feature at the same time until any extension is available.
UCD
UCD-
END
The system disconnects an incoming call via the UCD feature
when the assigned waiting time in [521] “UCD Busy Waiting
Time” expires.
5
6
UCD DISA1 An example: UCD is used in the day mode and DISA1 is used
in the night mode.
UCD
DISA
The system leads an incoming call via the UCD feature to the
DISA feature by OGM2 when the assigned waiting time in
[521] “UCD Busy Waiting Time” expires and “Intercept” is
selected in [523] “UCD Busy Mode”.
5
0
NEXT
2
SELECT
END
STORE
(MODE 1/
2/3/4/5/6)
Default
MODE1
• Programs [414]-[416] “Exchange Line Mode – Day/Night/Lunch” are used to assign
“DISA1”, “DISA2” or “UCD” to each exchange line according to this assignment.
• UCD-END is automatically used when “UCD” is assigned in programs [414]-[416],
“Disconnect” is selected in program [523] “UCD Busy Mode”, and “MODE4” is selected
in this program.
!
• DISA is automatically used when “UCD” is assigned in programs [414]-[416], “Intercept”
is selected in program [523], and “MODE6” is selected in this program.
• If the optional OGM/FAX Detection card is not installed, this assignment should be
“MODE1”.
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Outgoing Message (OGM),
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
System Programming
4-59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[503]-[505]
4.2
System Programming
1
[503] FAX Connection *
Assigns one extension which can receive facsimile data when the system receives a FAX
(CNG) tone via the DISA feature.
extension port no.
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
3
(01···24)
Default
Disable (Not assigned)
• The assigned extension will automatically have the Data Line Security feature set.
• To unassign an extension port number, press the CLEAR button in the extension port
number step.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Data Line Security, Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
[504] DISA Delayed Answer Time
Sets the time from a call being received and answered with the DISA feature.
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
4
SELECT
(0/3/6/12 sec
)
Default
3 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
1
[505] DISA Waiting Time after OGM *
Assigns the length of time the system keeps detecting the DTMF signals or FAX (CNG) tone
after the DISA outgoing message is completed.
END
5
STORE
5
0
NEXT
SELECT
(0/5/10/15 sec
)
Default
5 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
Card is installed.
4-60
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[506]-[507]
[506] DISA Busy Mode
Selects the operation when a called extension or all called extensions in an extension group
enabled in program [100] “Hunting Group Set” via the DISA feature is/are busy.
Disconnect, Call Waiting or DISA2 is available.
Disconnect: The call is disconnected after the busy tone.
Call Waiting: A call waiting tone is sent to the called extension or first called extension
in the hunting group.
DISA2:
OGM2 is sent to the caller and the system waits for another destination
when the first destination is busy.
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
6
SELECT
(Disconnect/
Call Waiting/
DISA2)
Default
Disconnect
• Program [502] “OGM Mode Selection” should be “MODE2”, if “DISA2” was selected in
this program.
!
☞
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Outgoing Message (OGM)
[507] DISA Intercept Mode
Selects the operation when a called extension or extension group via the DISA feature does
not answer a call within the length of time programmed in [508] “DISA Ringing Time
before Intercept”. Intercept or Disconnect is available.
Intercept: The call is redirected depending on [408]-[410] “Flexible Ringing
Assignment–Day/Night/Lunch” (Intercept Routing – No Answer feature).
This is useful for business use. For example, the call is forwarded to the
operator or a Voice Processing System automatically.
Disconnect: The call is disconnected. This is useful for users who do not want to
forward the call, for example, to a home.
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
7
SELECT
(Intercept/
Disconnect)
Default
Intercept
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Intercept Routing,
Voice Mail Integration for KX-TVP100
System Programming
4-61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[508]-[509]
4.2
System Programming
[508] DISA Ringing Time before Intercept
Assigns the length of time for the Intercept Routing – No Answer feature (☞ [507] “DISA
Intercept Mode”, Intercept). When the time expires the system starts to redirect the call to
the programmed extension(s).
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
8
SELECT
(10/20/30/
40/60/120 sec)
Default
20 seconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Intercept Routing
[509] DISA Ringing Time after Intercept
Assigns the length of time to call the extension(s) where a call is redirected by the Intercept
Routing – No Answer feature(☞ [507] “DISA Intercept Mode”, Intercept) after the time
programmed in [508] “DISA Ringing Time before Intercept” expires. If the call is not
answered within the programmed time, the call will be disconnected.
END
STORE
5
0
NEXT
9
SELECT
(10/20/30/
40/60/120 sec)
Default
20 seconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Intercept Routing
4-62
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[510], [513]
[510] DISA No Dial Mode
Selects the operation when the system does not receive either DTMF signals or a FAX
(CNG) tone after a programmed length of time. If the optional card is installed, then use
program [505] “DISA Waiting Time after OGM”. If the optional card is not installed, then
use program [515] “Intercept Time for Internal DISA”. Intercept or Disconnect is
available.
Intercept: The call is directed depending on programs [408]-[410] “Flexible Ringing
Assignment–Day/Night/Lunch” (Intercept Routing – No Answer feature).
The destination telephone(s) will ring for the time programmed in
[509] “DISA Ringing Time after Intercept”.
Disconnect: The call is disconnected.
END
STORE
5
1
NEXT
0
SELECT
(Intercept/
Disconnect)
(DISA1/
DISA2)
To continue
NEXT
Default
DISA 1 and DISA 2 – Intercept
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Intercept Routing
1
[513] Cyclic Tone Detection*
Assigns the number of times a cyclic tone is detected while the DISA outgoing message is
sent so that the system can recognise the end of the DISA call.
5
1
NEXT
3
SELECT
STORE
END
(Disable*/
2/3/4 Times)
* Disable (Does not detect)
Default 4 Times
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA), Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
Card is installed.
System Programming
4-63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[514]-[515]
4.2
System Programming
1
[514] FAX Tone Detection*
Sets the number of times the FAX (CNG) tone must be detected while the DISA outgoing
message is sent before the system recognises the incoming signal as facsimile data.
END
STORE
5
1
NEXT
4
SELECT
(1 Time/2 Times)
Default
1 Time
• The extension which can receive facsimile data must be assigned in program [503] “FAX
Connection”
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
[515] Intercept Time for Internal DISA
Assigns the length of time the system keeps detecting DTMF signals after a call is received
at the internal DISA. If the system does not receive DTMF signals within the programmed
time, the call will be intercepted or disconnected according to program [510] “DISA No Dial
Mode”.
5
5
1
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(3/6/9 sec
)
Default
3 seconds
• A cyclic tone and FAX (CNG) tone cannot be detected by the internal DISA.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
Card is installed.
4-64
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[516]-[517]
[516] DISA Incoming Assignment
Enables or disables each extension to receive an outside call via the DISA feature. If a
DISA call is received at a disabled extension, the DISA caller will hear a reorder tone and
the call will be disconnected automatically. For example, it may be convenient to disable the
president’s extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
6
SELECT
5
1
NEXT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Enable
• If a call via the DISA feature is received by an extension group, this program will not work
for extensions in that extension group. In this case, disabled extensions will still ring.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
[517] DISA AA Wait Time
Selects the time that the system waits for a second digit entry. If the programmed time
expires, the system will assume that the first digit is a DISA built-in auto attendant number,
if a number is assigned in program [501] “DISA Built-in Auto Attendant”. For example, if a
number is not dialled within the programmed time after dialling 1, the system will assume
that “1” is the auto attendant number.
END
STORE
5
1
7
NEXT
SELECT
(1/2/3/4/5 sec
)
Default
2 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
System Programming
4-65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[519]-[521]
4.2
System Programming
[519] DISA OGM Mute Time
Assigns the length of time from answering a call with the DISA feature and sending the
DISA outgoing message or a beep. During the assigned length of time, the system will not
receive DTMF signals.
5
1
NEXT
END
9
SELECT
STORE
(0/2/4/6 sec)
Default
0 second
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Direct Inward System Access (DISA)
1
[520] UCD Group*
Assigns one extension group which works as the UCD group.
extension group no.
5
2
NEXT
0
END
STORE
(1···8)
Default
Extension group number 1
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
[521] UCD Busy Waiting Time*
Assigns the length of time the system holds an incoming outside call via the UCD feature
when all extensions in the UCD group are busy. When the programmed time expires, the
call will be intercepted or disconnected according to program [523] “UCD Busy Mode”.
5
NEXT
waiting time*
1
2
SELECT
END
STORE
(min/sec)
* Waiting time: 1 through 32 (minutes) / 1 through 59 (seconds)
Default 10 minutes
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
Card is installed.
4-66
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[522]-[523]
1
[522] UCD OGM Message Interval Time*
Assigns interval time between sending UCD outgoing messages to an incoming outside call
via the UCD feature when all extensions in the UCD group are busy. The UCD outgoing
message is repeated during the time programmed in [521] “UCD Busy Waiting Time”.
5
2
NEXT
2
SELECT
END
STORE
(30 sec/1/
1.5/2 min)
Default
1 minute
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
[523] UCD Busy Mode*
Selects the operation when the length of time programmed in [521] “UCD Busy Waiting
Time” expires. Intercept or Disconnect is available.
Intercept: The call will be redirected depending on programs [408]-[410] “Flexible
Ringing Assignment–Day/Night/Lunch” (Intercept Routing feature). The
extension which receives a redirected call rings during the length of time
programmed in [526] “UCD Ringing Time after Intercept”.
Disconnect: The call will be disconnected immediately.
5
2
NEXT
3
SELECT
END
STORE
(Intercept/
Disconnect)
Default
Intercept
• The above-mentioned intercept only occurs when “MODE 3” or “MODE 5” is selected in
program [502] “OGM Mode Selection”. If “MODE 4” is selected, the call will be
disconnected after the UCD-END outgoing message. If “MODE 6” is selected and
“Intercept” is assigned in this program, the call will go to the DISA and OGM2 will be
heard by the caller.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Intercept Routing, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
Card is installed.
System Programming
4-67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[524]-[526]
4.2
System Programming
1
[524] UCD Intercept Mode*
Selects the operation when all extensions in the UCD group do not answer an outside call
via the UCD feature within the length of time programmed in [525] “UCD Ringing Time
before Intercept”. Intercept or Disconnect is available.
Intercept: The call is redirected depending on programs [408]-[410] “Flexible Ringing
Assignment–Day/Night/Lunch” (Intercept Routing – No Answer feature).
Disconnect: The call is disconnected.
5
2
NEXT
4
SELECT
END
STORE
(Intercept/
Disconnect)
Default
Intercept
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Intercept Routing, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
[525] UCD Ringing Time before Intercept*
Assigns the length of time for the Intercept Routing – No Answer feature (☞ [524] “UCD
Intercept Mode”, Intercept). When the time expires, the system starts to redirect the call to
the programmed extension(s).
5
2
NEXT
5
SELECT
END
STORE
(10/20/30/
40/60/120 sec)
Default
20 seconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Intercept Routing, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept*
Assigns the length of time to call the extension(s) where a call is redirected by the Intercept
Routing – No Answer feature (☞ [524] “UCD Intercept Mode”, Intercept) after the time
programmed in [525] “UCD Ringing Time before Intercept” expires.
STORE
5
2
NEXT
6
SELECT
END
(10/20/30/
40/60/120 sec)
Default
20 seconds
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Intercept Routing, Uniform Call Distribution (UCD)
1
* : Required only when the optional OGM/FAX Detection
4-68
System Programming
Card is installed.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[600]-[603]
[600] Extension Group Assignment
Assigns an extension group for each extension. For example: by department or floor.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
1
2
extension port no.* extension group no.*
NEXT
END
6
0
0
STORE
(01···24/
)
(1···8)
To continue
SELECT
1
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
2
* Extension group number: 1 through 8
Default
All extension ports – Extension group 1
• Every extension should belong to an extension group, but cannot belong to more than one
group.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Extension Group, Extension Hunting
[601]-[603] Call Barring – Class of Service Assignment —Day/Night/Lunch
Programs a class of service (COS) in the day, night and/or lunch modes for each extension.
There are 5 classes of service available for each extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
COS no.
NEXT
X
6
0
END
(01···24/
)
(1···5 )
(1···3)
To continue
SELECT
X – Program address selection number: 1 ([601] for day) / 2 ([602] for night)/
3 ([603] for lunch)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default
All extension ports – COS-1
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Barring
☞
System Programming
4-69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[604]
4.2
System Programming
[604] Extension Name Setting
Assigns a name to each extension which will be displayed when making or receiving an
intercom call.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no. extension name*
NEXT
END
6
0
4
(01···24 )
10 characters
max.
To continue
SELECT
* Extension name:
Combination Table
Pressing SELECT
(Times)
Keys
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
1
Q
A
D
G
J
2
q
a
3
Z
B
E
H
K
N
R
U
X
,
4
z
5
!
6
?
c
f
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
0
b
e
C
F
I
d
g
j
h
k
n
r
i
L
O
S
V
Y
:
l
M
P
m
p
t
o
s
T
u
x
’
=
@
v
y
W
w
.
+
%
;
>
)
”
$
-
&
<
(
#
#
<Example>
— To enter “Mike”;
1. Press 6 and then press the SELECT button once to enter “M”.
2. Press 4 and then press the SELECT button 6 times to enter “i”.
3. Press 5 and then press the SELECT button 4 times to enter “k”.
4. Press 3 and then press the SELECT button 4 times to enter “e”.
Default
All extension ports – Not stored.
• To erase all letters, press the CLEAR button. To erase 1 letter, press
• Each name has a maximum of 10 characters.
.
!
☞
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
Intercom Calling
4-70
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[605]
[605] Account Code Entry Mode
Selects the account code input mode, Option, Forced, Verify–All or Verify–Toll (Call
Barring), for each extension port. This feature displays the account code of the called or
calling party on the SMDR.
Option:
The user can enter any account code, if needed.
Forced:
The user must always enter an account code. The code can be any number.
Verify–All: The user must always enter an assigned account code in program
[310] “Account Codes” to make an outside call.
Verify–Toll (Call Barring): The user can enter an assigned account code in program
[310] to override call barring. The call barring COS
numbers 3 through 5 will be changed temporarily to the
COS number 2. (The COS numbers 1 and 2 will not be
changed.)
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
NEXT
END
6
0
5
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Option/Forced/
Verify-All/Verify-Toll)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Option
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Account Code Entry, Call Barring Override by Account Codes
System Programming
4-71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[606]-[607]
4.2
System Programming
[606] Call Transfer to an Exchange Line
Enables or disables transferring an intercom or outside call to any exchange line manually
for each extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
NEXT
6
0
6
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Call Transfer – to Exchange Line, Conference (3-party)
[607] Call Forwarding to an Exchange Line
Enables or disables automatically forwarding an incoming intercom or outside call to any
exchange line for each extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
NEXT
6
0
SELECT
END
7
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Forwarding
☞
4-72
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[608]-[609]
[608] Executive Busy Override
Enables or disables using the Executive Busy Override feature at each extension. If enabled,
an extension user can interrupt an established call.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
NEXT
6
0
8
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Executive Busy Override
[609] Do Not Disturb Override
Enables or disables using the Do Not Disturb Override feature at each extension. If enabled,
an extension user can ring an extension which has set the Do Not Disturb feature.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
NEXT
6
0
9
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Do Not Disturb (DND)
System Programming
4-73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[610]-[611]
4.2
System Programming
[610] Parallelled Telephone Connection
Enables or disables a single line telephone (SLT) to be connected in parallel with a
proprietary telephone.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
NEXT
6
1
SELECT
0
END
(01···16/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 16 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Parallelled Telephone Connection
[611] TAM (Telephone Answering Machine) Extension
Assigns the port number of an extension connected to a telephone answering machine
(TAM) to activate the Call Retrieving from TAM feature.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
6
1
1
NEXT
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable (not connected)
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Call Pickup
☞
4-74
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[612]-[613]
[612] Room Monitor Assignment
Enables or disables which extension(s) can be monitored using the Room Monitor feature.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
6
1
2
NEXT
SELECT
(01···16/
)
(Enable/
Disable) To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 16 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable (Cannot be monitored.)
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Room Monitor
☞
[613] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit Selection
Enables or disables the time limit programmed in [212] “Exchange Line Duration Time
Limit” for each extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
END
6
1
3
NEXT
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
Limited Call Duration
System Programming
4-75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[614]
4.2
System Programming
[614] Internal Pulse Detection
Enables or disables connecting a single line telephone (SLT) to receive pulse signals for each
extension.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
6
1
4
NEXT
SELECT
END
(01···24/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Enable
• If you select “MODE 1” in program [207] “Recall Timing Range Selection” and “Enable”
in this program, the system will distinguish between a pulse signal and hooking depending
on the situation. When you select “Disable” in this program, if “1” is dialled during the
pulse mode, the system will regard it as hooking and all other numbers will be disregarded.
!
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Recall Button on a Single Line Telephone
4-76
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[615]
[615] LCD Language Assignment
Selects the language, English, Spanish or Portuguese, shown on the LCD display of a
proprietary telephone on an extension basis. The selected language is shown during
operation and Proprietary Telephone Settings.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
extension port no.*
6
1
5
NEXT
SELECT
END
(01···16/
)
(English/Spanish
Portuguese)
To continue
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 16 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports — English
• The language used for the SMDR printout is assigned in program [806] “SMDR Language
Assignment”.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Language Selection
System Programming
4-77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[700]-[702]
4.2
System Programming
[700]-[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment—Day/Night/Lunch
Enables or disables receiving a call from up to 4 doorphones in the day, night and/or lunch
modes for each extension.
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
Go to next or prev. doorphone number
or
To continue
Go to next or prev.
port number
1
extension
port no.*
(01···24/
doorphone no.*
X
7
NEXT
SELECT STORE
END
#
2
(1···4/
)
(00···02)
(Enable/
Disable)
)
To continue
Go to another port number
To continue
SELECT
Go to another doorphone number
X – Program address selection number: 00 ([700] for day) / 01 ([701] for night) /
02 ([702] for lunch)
* Doorphone number: 1 through 4 / (All doorphones)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
2
Default
All doorphones – all extension ports – Enable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Doorphone Call
☞
4-78
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[703]-[705]
[703]-[705] Door Opener Assignment—Day/Night/Lunch
Enables or disables accessing to up to 4 door openers in the day, night and/or lunch modes
for each extension.
or
PREV
To continue
NEXT
Go to next or prev. door opener number
or
To continue
Go to next or prev.
port number
1
extension
port no.*
(01···24/
door opener no.*
X
7
NEXT
SELECT STORE
END
#
2
(1···4/
)
(03···05)
(Enable/
Disable)
)
To continue
Go to another port number
To continue
SELECT
Go to another door opener number
X – Program address selection number: 03 ([703] for day) / 04 ([704] for night) /
05 ([705] for lunch)
* Door opener number: 1 through 4 / (All door openers)
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
1
2
Default
All door openers – all extension ports – Disable
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Door Opener
☞
System Programming
4-79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[706]-[707]
4.2
System Programming
[706] Doorphone Ringing / Tone Pattern Selection
Selects the doorphone ringing pattern, Single, Double, Triple or S-Double.
1 s
Single:
Double:
Triple:
S-Double:
doorphone no.*
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
7
0
6
(1···4/
)
(Single/Double/
Triple/S-Double)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
* Doorphone number: 1 through 4 / (All doorphones)
Default All doorphones – Triple
• When a doorphone call is received at a proprietary telephone, a tone is heard instead of
ringing.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Doorphone Call, Ringing Pattern Selection
[707] Doorphone Access Tone Selection
Enables or disables sending a doorphone access tone to a monitored doorphone. If enabled,
the access tone is heard from the doorphone when monitoring from a telephone starts.
doorphone no.*
END
7
0
7
SELECT
STORE
NEXT
(1···4/
)
(Enable/
Disable)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
* Doorphone number: 1 through 4 / (All doorphones)
Default All doorphones – Enable
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Doorphone Call, Room Monitor
4-80
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[708]-[709]
[708] Doorphone Ringing Time
Sets the ringing time when making an intercom call from a doorphone.
doorphone no.*
END
7
0
8
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
(1···4/
)
(15/30 sec)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
* Doorphone number: 1 through 4 / (All doorphones)
Default All doorphones – 15 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Doorphone Call
☞
[709] Door Opener Time
Assigns the length of the door opener time. The door is unlocked for the assigned period of
time.
door opener no.*
END
STORE
7
0
9
NEXT
SELECT
(1···4/
)
(1/2/3/4/5/
6/7/8 sec)
To continue
or
PREV
NEXT
* Door opener number: 1 through 4 / (All door openers)
Default All door openers – 5 seconds
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Door Opener
☞
System Programming
4-81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[800]
4.2
System Programming
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters
Assigns the communication parameters for the Serial Interface (RS-232C).
NL–Code:
Selects the code for your printer or personal computer. If your printer or
personal computer automatically feeds lines with a carriage return, select
“CR”. If not, select “CR+LF”.
(New line)
Baud Rate:
The baud rate code indicates the data transmission speed from the system
to the printer or personal computer.
Word Length: The word length code indicates how many bits compose a character.
Parity:
The parity code indicates what type of parity is used to detect an error in
the string of bits composing a character. Make your selection depending
on the requirements of your printer or personal computer.
The stop bit code indicates the end of a bit string which composes a
character. Select a value depending on the requirements of your printer
or personal computer.
Stop Bit:
< Sets the new line code>
< Sets the baud rate >
STORE
SELECT
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
8
0
0
NEXT
1
(150/300/600/
1200/2400/
(CR+LF/CR)*
4800/9600 B)
< Sets the word length >
< Sets the parity >
< Sets the stop bit length >
STORE
STORE
STORE
END
NEXT
SELECT
NEXT
SELECT
NEXT
SELECT
(7/8 bits)
(1 bit/2 bits)
(Mark/Space/
Even/Odd/
2
None* )
1
* CR+LF (Carriage Return + Line Feed) / CR (Carriage Return)
2
* Select “None” when the error checking function is not required from the printer.
Default
New line Baud rate Word length
CR + LF 9600 baud 8 bits
Parity
Mark
Stop bit length
1 bit
PREV
NEXT
• To return to the previous mode, press
• The following combinations are invalid.
instead of
.
!
Parity
Word length Stop bit length
Mark
Space
Space
8
8
8
2
1
2
If any of the above invalid combinations are selected, an alarm tone is heard.
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
4-82
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[801]-[802]
[801] SMDR Parameter
Assigns the following 2 printing parameters to match the SMDR output with the paper size
used in the printer.
Page Length: Sets the number of lines per page.
Skip Perf:
Sets the number of lines to be skipped at the end of every page.
(Perforation)
< Sets the page length >
page length
8
0
1
NEXT
STORE
(4···99)
< Sets the skip perforation >
skip perforation
END
STORE
NEXT
(0···95)
<Example>
Default
Page length – 66 lines
Skip perforation – 0 line
Standard paper
for the SMDR
(11 inches)
• The page length should be at least 4 lines
longer than the skip perforation length.
page
length
!
66 lines
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR
button and enter the new one.
skip
perforation
• Feature Reference
☞
Section 3, Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
machine
perforation
[802] Incoming/Outgoing Call Selection for Printing
Determines which calls will produce an SMDR printout.
< Sets an outgoing call >
< Sets an incoming call >
SELECT
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
8
0
2
NEXT
STORE
END
2
1
(On/Off)*
(On/Off/Toll)*
1
* Outgoing: On (Print all calls) / Off (No printing) / Toll (Print toll calls only)
2
* Incoming: On (Print all calls) / Off (No printing)
Default
Outgoing calls / Incoming calls – On
• If “Outgoing; Toll” is selected, only calls which are checked in programs [302]–[305] “Call
Barring – Classes 2 through 5 Denied Codes” and are allowed, are printed out.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
System Programming
4-83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[803]-[804]
4.2
System Programming
[803] Secret Speed Dialling / One-Touch Dialling Printing
Selects to print or not print (on SMDR) secret dialling numbers stored in program [001]
“System Speed Dialling Entry” and/or stored in One-Touch Dialling even though they are
not displayed on the LCD.
SELECT
END
STORE
8
0
NEXT
3
(No Printing/
Printing)
Default
No printing
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Secret Dialling, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
[804] System Data Dump
Starts and stops printing the assigned data. All or a specific area of current system-
programmed data is printed out. The areas are as follows.
All Para: Prints out all data.
System Para: Prints out all data except for the following 4 parameters.
CO Para:
Ext Para:
Prints out programs [400] through [403] and [405] through [424].
If the extension is a proprietary telephone, programs [102], [516] [600]
through [613] and [615] will be printed out. The assigned data on the PF
(Programmable Feature) buttons and line keys will also be printed out.
If the extension is a single line telephone, programs [102], [516] and [600]
through [614] will be printed out. The assigned Personal Speed Dialling
numbers are also printed out.
DSS Para: Prints out the assigned data in the DSS buttons and PF buttons on the DSS
console.
Speed Dial: Prints out the System Speed Dialling numbers and names assigned in
programs [001] and [011].
Stop Output : Stops printing.
< To select All parameters, System parameter,
Speed dial and/or Stop output. >
END
STORE
8
0
4
NEXT
SELECT
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial/
Stop Output)
To continue
4-84
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[804]-[805]
< To select the CO (exchange line) parameter. >
exchange line
END
END
END
STORE
NEXT
8
0
4
SELECT
STORE
(1···6/
)
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial/
Stop Output)
To continue
< To select the Extension parameter. >
2
extension port no.* STORE
NEXT
8
0
4
SELECT
STORE
(01···24/
)
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial/
Stop Output)
To continue
< To select the DSS parameter. >
3
STORE
DSS console no.*
8
0
4
NEXT
(All/System/CO/Ext/
SELECT
STORE
(1···2/ )
DSS Para/Speed Dial/
To continue
Stop Output)
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
2
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
3
* DSS console number: 1 through 2 / (Both DSS console numbers)
• This program and [999] “System Data Clear” are not included.
!
☞
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
[805] SMDR Account Code Selection
Selects printing out the account code stored in program [310] “Account Codes”, or just the
index of the account code on SMDR printout.
SELECT
END
STORE
8
0
5
NEXT
(CODE/
INDEX)
Default
CODE
• The printing of the index of the account code only occurs if the extension user entered their
account code in the “Verify-All” or “Verify-Toll (Call Barring)” input mode as programmed
in [605] “Account Code Entry Mode”.
!
• Feature References
☞
Section 3, Features
Account Code Entry, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
System Programming
4-85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[806], [998]
4.2
System Programming
[806] SMDR Language Assignment
Selects the language, English, Spanish or Portuguese, used for an SMDR printout.
8
0
6
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
END
(English/Spanish
Portuguese)
Default
English
• Feature References
Section 3, Features
☞
Language Selection, Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
[998] ROM Version
Confirms the system ROM version.
END
9
9
8
NEXT
Display example:
Y551JA 990620 (E)
Version
Date
4-86
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4.2
System Programming
[999]
[999] System Data Clear
Resets all or a specific area of the current assigned data to the default settings. The areas are
as follows.
All Para :
Resets all data to the default settings.
System Para: Resets all data to the default settings except for the data of the following
4 parameters.
CO Para:
Ext Para:
DSS Para:
Resets programs [400] through [403] and [405] through [424] to the
default settings on an exchange line basis.
Resets programs [102], [516] and [600] through [615] to the default
settings on an extension basis.
Resets the assigned data on the DSS buttons and PF buttons on the DSS
console.
Speed Dial : Resets the System Speed Dialling numbers (00 through 99) assigned in
program [001].
< To select All, System parameter and/or Speed Dial. >
END
STORE
9
9
9
NEXT
SELECT
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial)
To continue
< To select the CO (exchange line) parameter. >
1
exchange line no.*
END
STORE
9
9
9
NEXT
SELECT
STORE
(1···6/
)
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial)
To continue
< To select the Extension parameter. >
2
extension port no.*
END
STORE
9
9
9
NEXT
STORE
SELECT
(01···24/
)
(All/System/CO/Ext/
DSS Para/Speed Dial)
To continue
< To select the DSS parameter. >
3
9
9
9
NEXT
(All/System/CO/Ext/
END
SELECT
STORE
STORE
DSS console no.*
(1···2/ )
DSS Para/Speed Dial)
To continue
1
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
2
* Extension port number: 01 through 24 / (All extension ports)
3
* DSS console number: 1 through 2 / (Both DSS console numbers)
• This program and [804] “System Data Dump” are not included.
!
• Feature Reference
Section 3, Features
☞
System Data Default Set
System Programming
4-87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
4-88
System Programming
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 5
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.1
Default Values
Address
Program
Default
[000] Date and Time Setting
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[002] System Password
’98 Jan. 1 Thu 12:00 AM
All speed dialling numbers – Not stored
1234
[003] DSS Console Port Assignment
All DSS Consoles — Disable
DSS1 – Disable, DSS2 – Disable
[004] Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS
Console
[005] One-Touch Transfer Using a DSS Button
With Transfer
Manual
[006] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing
Mode
[007] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time Every day of the week
— Day – 9:00 AM / Night – 5:30 PM /
Lunch-S – None / Lunch-E – None
[008] Operator Assignment
Jack-01
[009] Extension Number Assignment
[010] LCD Time Display Selection
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
[012] Alternative Feature Numbering Plan
[100] Hunting Group Set
Port 01 through 24 = Extn. 201 through 224
12 HOUR
All System Speed Dialling numbers – Not stored
All codes — Not stored
All extension groups — Disable
[101] Hunting Type
All extension groups – Terminate
[102] Voice Mail Port for KX-TVP100
[103] DTMF Integration for KX-TVP100
[104] Hold Mode Selection
All 4 extension ports — Disable
Disable
Hold-1
[105] Conference Tone
Enable
[106] External Paging Access Tone
[107] DTMF Receiver Check
Enable
All DTMF receivers — Enable
[108] Recall Mode for a Locked Extension
[109] CO Indicator Assignment
[110] Recall Key Mode
Disable
Enable
MODE 1
External
Enable
[111] Hold Music Selection
[112] DSS Console Indication Mode
[115] Extension Ringing Pattern Selection
[116] Conference Pattern Selection
[117] Call Pickup Tone
Single
5-party C-2 E-5
Enable
5-2
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.1
Default Values
Address
Program
Default
[118] Pulse Restriction
Enable
Disable
25 Hz
[119] Redialling after Pulse to Tone Conversion
[120] Bell Frequency
[121] Automatic Exchange Line Access Number
Selection
Dial 9
[122] Automatic Rotation for Exchange Line
Access
Disable
[123] Break Ratio
MODE 1
MODE 2
Enable
[124] SLT Ringing Mode Selection
[125] Call Barring Check for
[126] DSS Off-Hook Mode
[127] Pickup Group Set
and #
Enable
All extension groups – Disable
30 seconds
[200] Hold Recall Time
[201] Transfer Recall Time
[202] Call Forwarding Start Time
[203] Pickup Dial Delay Time
30 seconds
15 seconds delay
3 seconds
[204] Call Duration Count Start Time
[206] Dialling Start Time
10 seconds after dialling
0 millisecond
MODE 1
[207] Recall Timing Range Selection
[208] Interdigit Time
20 seconds
[210] DTMF Time
MODE 1
[211] No Dial Disconnection
[212] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit
[213] Bell Off Detection
Enable
10 minutes
3 seconds
[300] Carrier Excepted Code Assignment
All codes – Not stored
Boundary Class-1
[301] Call Barring — System Speed Dialling
Boundary Class
[302]–[305] Call Barring — Classes 2 through 5 All codes – Not stored
Denied Codes
[306] Call Barring — Exception Codes
[309] Emergency Dial Number Set
[310] Account Codes
All codes – Not stored
Code-01 = 999, Code-02 = 112, Other codes = Not stored
All codes – Not stored
[311] Automatic Pause Insertion Codes
All codes – Not stored
Appendix
5-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.1
Default Values
Address
Program
Default
[312] Call Barring — Extension Lock Boundary Class Disable
[350] ARS Selection
All exchange lines – Disable
[351]-[354] Routes 1 through 4 Selection Codes All codes – Not stored
(Leading Digits)
[355]-[358] Routes 1 through 4 Exception Codes All codes – Not stored
[359] 1st Carrier Selection Code
(BT Line Access Code)
121 (British Telecom Line access code)
[360] ARS Modification — Removed Digits
[361] ARS Modification — Added Number
[362] ARS Dial Tone Pattern Selection
[363] ARS Interdigit Time
All routes – 0 (No deletion)
Route 1 = 131, Other routes = Not stored
Tone 1
5 seconds
[364] ARS Trunk Grorup
All routes –
(All trunk (TRK) groups)
[381]-[384] Routes 1 through 4 Authorisation
Codes
All exchange lines – Not stored
[385]-[388] Routes 1 through 4 Itemised Bill
[389] Itemised Bill Code Assignment
[400] Exchange Line Connection Assignment
[401] Dial Mode
All exchange lines – Disable
Extension ports 01 through 24 – 201 through 224
All exchange lines – Connect
All exchange lines – DTMF Mode
All exchange lines – Low Speed
All exchange lines – Not stored
[402] Pulse Speed Selection
[403] Host PBX Access Codes
[404] Trunk Group Assignment
CO1 — TRK GRP-1; CO2 — TRK GRP-2;
CO3 — TRK GRP-3; CO4 — TRK GRP-4;
CO5 — TRK GRP-5; CO6 — TRK GRP-6;
[405]–[407] Flexible Outward Dialling
Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
All exchange lines – all extension ports – Enable
— Day/Night/Lunch
[408]–[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
All exchange lines – all extension ports – Enable
— Day/Night/Lunch
[411]–[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
All exchange lines – all extension ports – Immdtly
— Day/Night/Lunch
[414]–[416] Exchange Line Mode
— Day/Night/Lunch
All exchange lines — Normal
— Day/Night/Lunch
[417] Pause Time
[418] Recall Time
All exchange lines — 1.5 seconds
All exchange lines – 100 milliseconds
[419] Automatic Designated Exchange Line Access All exchange lines — Enable
5-4
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.1
Default Values
Address
Program
Default
All exchange lines – 00 (Disable)
All exchange lines – Disable
All exchange lines – 2.0 seconds
All exchange lines – Double
All exchange lines – Disable
Without AA
[420] Calling Party Control (CPC) Signal
[421] CPC Detection for Outgoing Calls
[422] Disconnect Time
[423] Exchange Line Ringing Pattern Selection
[424] Reverse (Polarity) Circuit Assignment
[500] DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection
[501] DISA Built-in Auto Attendant
[502] OGM Mode Selection
All numbers — Not Stored
MODE 1
[503] FAX Connection
Disable
[504] DISA Delayed Answer Time
[505] DISA Waiting Time after OGM
[506] DISA Busy Mode
3 seconds
5 seconds
Disconnect
[507] DISA Intercept Mode
Intercept
[508] DISA Ringing Time before Intercept
[509] DISA Ringing Time after Intercept
[510] DISA No Dial Mode
20 seconds
20 seconds
DISA1 and DISA2 — Intercept
4 Times
[513] Cyclic Tone Detection
[514] Fax Tone Detection
1 Time
[515] Intercept Time for Internal DISA
[516] DISA Incoming Assignment
[517] DISA AA Wait Time
3 seconds
All extension ports — Enable
2 seconds
[519] DISA OGM Mute Time
0 second
[520] UCD Group
Group – 1
[521] UCD Busy Waiting Time
[522] UCD OGM Message Interval Time
[523] UCD Busy Mode
10 minutes
1 minute
Intercept
[524] UCD Intercept Mode
Intercept
[525] UCD Ringing Time before Intercept
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept
[600] Extension Group Assignment
20 seconds
20 seconds
All extension ports — EXT GRP-1
[601]–[603] Call Barring – Class of Service
Assignment — Day/Night/Lunch
All extension ports — COS-1
— Day/Night/Lunch
Appendix
5-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.1
Default Values
Address
Program
Default
All extension ports – Not stored
All extension ports – Option
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
[604] Extension Name Setting
[605] Account Code Entry Mode
[606] Call Transfer to an Exchange Line
[607] Call Forwarding to an Exchange Line
[608] Executive Busy Override
[609] Do Not Disturb Override
[610] Parallelled Telephone Connection
[611] TAM (Telephone Answering Machine)
Extension
[612] Room Monitor Assignment
All extension ports – Disable
All extension ports – Disable
[613] Exchange Line Duration Time Limit
Selection
[614] Internal Pulse Detection
All extension ports – Enable
All extension ports – English
[615] LCD Language Assignment
[700]–[702] Doorphone Ringing Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
All doorphones — all extension ports – Enable
— Day/Night/Lunch
[703]–[705] Door Opener Assignment
— Day/Night/Lunch
All door openers – all extension ports – Disable
— Day/Night/Lunch
[706] Doorphone Ringing/Tone Pattern Selection
[707] Doorphone Access Tone Selection
[708] Doorphone Ringing Time
All doorphones — Triple
All doorphones — Enable
All doorphones — 15 seconds
All door openers — 5 seconds
[709] Door Opener Time
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters New line code = CR+LF; Baud rate = 9600;
Word length = 8; Parity = Mark; Stop bit = 1
[801] SMDR Parameter
Page length – 66; Skip perforation – 0
Outgoing calls – On; Incoming calls – On
[802] Incoming/Outgoing Call Selection for
Printing
[803] Secret Speed Dialling/One Touch Dialling
Printing
No printing
[805] SMDR Account Code Selection
[806] SMDR Language Assignment
CODE
English
5-6
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.2
Specifications
System Capacity
Exchange Lines: 3 max. (6 max. with 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion
Card)
Extensions
: 8 max. (24 max. with 3-CO Line & 8 Ext Expansion
Card and 8 SLT Extension Expansion Card)
Control Method
CPU: 16 bit CPU
Control ROM: 4 Mbit, Control RAM: 1 Mbit
Switching
Space Division CMOS Crosspoint Switch
Power Supplies
Primary: 230 V AC – 240 V AC, 50 Hz (0.5 A)
Secondary: Circuit Volt (+5 V, +26 V)
Dialling
Dial Pulse (DP):10 pps, 20 pps
Tone (DTMF) Dialling, DTMF–DP
Intercom Paths
Connector
4
Exchange Lines
: 2-pin Modular Connector (RJ11)
Extensions/Doorphone: 4-pin Modular Connector
Pager/Music Source : EIAJ RC-6701 A plug (two-conductor, ø 3.5 mm
in diameter)
Extension Connection Cable
KX-T7020 / KX-T7130 / KX-T7050 . . . . . . .2 pair wire (A, B, H, L)
Single Line Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1 pair wire (A, B)
SMDR (Station Message Detail Interface
: Serial Interface (RS-232C) (D-SUB, 9-pin)
Recording)
Output Equipment: Printer
Detail Recording : Date, Time, Extension Number, Exchange Line
Number, Dialled Number, Call Duration, Account
Code
Extension Loop Limit
KX-T7020 / KX-T7130 / KX-T7050 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Ω
Single Line Telephones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .600 Ω including set
Doorphones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20 Ω
Minimum Leakage Resistance
15 000 Ω
Maximum Number of Extension 1 for a KX-T7020 / KX-T7130 / KX-T7050 or single line telephone
Instruments per Line
2 for by parallel connection of a proprietary telephone and a single line
telephone
Ring Voltage
80 Vrms at 25 Hz depending on the Ringing Load
1 600 Ω max.
Local Exchange Loop Limit
Environmental Requirements
Recall Timing Range
0 ˚C – 40 ˚C, 10 % – 90% relative humidity
80 ms – 1 000 ms
Ability To Recognise Further
Digits
The KX-TA624 is capable of accepting and acting upon routing
information received from a proprietary telephone for 10 seconds, after
the latest routing information has been received.
(Satisfies BS6450:Part 1 1993 Clause 13.5.)
Appendix
5-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.2
Specifications
Maximum associated cable loss PT: Max cable loss 0.34 dB (140 m max for ø 0.5 mm)
for EXTN. port
SLT:Max cable loss 0.87 dB (698 m max for ø 0.5 mm)
Port to port loss
Loss across switch, PAS →1AS Loss=1.13 dB (Not through–fed system)
Send and receive loudness
ratings on port to port basis
Send loudness rating (1AS →PAS) : +3dB (0km)
Receive loudness rating (PAS →1AS) : -6 dB (0km)
Extension (1AS) port
3 ringers can be supported with extension wiring up to 698 m.
Notes
• Extension ports 01 through 24 may be used for off premise extensions in which
case cabling would be required by BS 6701:Part 1 1986 to be equipped with
over voltage protection.
• When using separately approved extension telephones, the best overall
performance of the PBX system will be obtained by using extension telephones
of impedance class A clause 4.3.2.1. of BS 6305:1982.
Port Type Classification
Port Name
Brief Description
Connect to PT, SLT
Connect to Network
External Paging
Port Type
Extn. Port**
1 AS
PAS
4F
PSTN Port**
Paging Port (output)*
Ext. Music Port (input)*
Doorphone Port*
Door Opener Port
EIA (RS-232C) Port
External Music
4F
Connect to KX-T30865
Door Opener
4E
4F
Connect to PC, Printer
4E
* These ports do not respond to address signalling.
** These ports provide DTMF and Loop Disconnect Signalling.
Port Types between which Call Paths can be established
Ext.
Door-
Door
EIA
To
Extn.
PSTN Paging
Music Phone Opener (RS-232C)
From
Extn.
A
A
X
A
A
X
X
A
A
X
A
X
X
X
A
X
X
A
X
X
X
X
X
A
X
X
X
X
X
PSTN
X
X
X
X
Paging
N/A
X
X
X
X
Ext. Music
Doorphone
Door Opener
EIA (RS-232C)
N/A
X
X
X
X
N/A
X
X
X
X
N/A
A: Allowed X: Not allowed N/A: Not applicable.
5-8
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5.2
Specifications
Lines, Cards, Extension Equipment
Item
Max. Quantity
Service Units
1
Exchange lines
6
24
40
1
Extension ports
Extension Terminals
3-CO Line and 8 Ext Expansion Card
8 SLT Extension Expansion Card
OGM/FAX Detection Card
Doorphone/Door Opener Card
Doorphones
1
1
1
4
Door Openers
4
External Pager
1
External Music Source
DSS Consoles
1
2
System Data
Item
Max. Quantity
Operator
1
System Speed Dialling
One Touch Dialling
100
24 per extension
(Proprietary telephone)
Personal Speed Dialling
Call Park areas
10 per extension
10
Absent Messages
Call Barring Classes
Extension Groups
Message Waitings
6
5
8
8 per extension
Appendix
5-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5-10
Appendix
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 6
Troubleshooting
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6.1
While Installing
PROBLEM
PROBABLE CAUSE
POSSIBLE SOLUTION
Extension does not
operate.
Something is wrong with
the printed circuit board
(Extension Card).
Exchange the printed circuit board
with another printed circuit board.
Something is wrong with
Take the extension and plug it into
the connection between the the same extension port using a
system and extension.
short telephone cord. If the
telephone works correctly, the
connection between the system and
the extension must be repaired.
A telephone with an A-A1 Use a 2 wire cord.
relay is connected.
Set the A-A1 relay switch on the
telephone to the “OUT” or “OFF”
position.
Something is wrong with
the extension.
Take the extension and plug it into
another extension port that is
working. If the telephone does not
work, replace the phone.
Improper reset operation.
Turn the Power Switch “OFF” and
then “ON”.
Noise during external
paging.
Induced noise on the wire
between the system and the connection wire between the
Use a shielded cable as the
amplifier.
system and amplifier. A short
shielded cable is recommended.
Volume distortion from
external music source.
Excessive input level from Decrease the output level of the
external music source.
external music source by using the
volume control on the music
source.
Speed Dialling or
One-Touch Dialling does
not function.
Wrong programming.
Enter an exchange line access
number (9 or 0, 81 through 86) in
programming.
A proprietary telephone
An extension (H, L) port 01 Turn the Power Switch “OFF”.
connected to extension ports through 08, 09 through 16, Fix the shorted part, then turn the
01 through 08, 09 through
16, or 17 through 24 does
not operate, but a single line
telephone operates.
or 17 through 24 may have Power Switch “ON”.
been shorted.
6-2
Troubleshooting
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6.2
While Connecting
Connection between the system and a proprietary telephone:
CAUSE
SOLUTION
A/B is connected to H/L.
Use the correct cord
(the inner 2 wires are for A/B
and the outer 2 wires are for
H/L).
H •
A •
B •
L •
• H
• A
• B
• L
No
Can you dial an
extension?
KX-TA624
Extension
Connection between the system and a single line telephone:
CAUSE
SOLUTION
A/B is connected to H/L.
Use the correct cord
(the inner 2 wires are for
A/B).
H •
A •
B •
L •
•
• A
• B
•
KX-TA624
Extension
Connection between the system and a single line telephone that is polarity-
sensitive:
Yes
CAUSE
SOLUTION
“A” is connected to “B”.
Reverse the connections of
A/B.
H •
A •
B •
L •
•
• A
• B
•
KX-TA624
Extension
Connection between the Local Exchange and the system:
CAUSE
SOLUTION
Exchange lines are connected to H/L.
Reconnect the exchange lines
to A/B using 2-conductor
wiring.
Can you dial
out using an
exchange line?
•
No
•
•
• A
• B
•
Exchange line
KX-TA624
Troubleshooting
6-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
6.3
While Operating
PROBLEM
PROBABLE CAUSE
POSSIBLE SOLUTION
When using the
The HANDSET/HEADSET Set the HANDSET/HEADSET selector
speakerphone with a
proprietary telephone,
KX-T7130, nothing is
heard.
selector on the KX-T7130
is set to the “HEADSET”
position.
to the “HANDSET” position.
The unit does not ring.
The Ringer Volume
Set to “HIGH” or “LOW”.
Selector is set to “OFF”.
During a power failure, A proprietary telephone is
the extension connected connected to the port.
to port number 01 or 09
Disconnect the proprietary telephone
and connect a single line telephone.
does not operate.
Making an outside call
cannot be performed.
The corresponding line key Program the line key. See the Flexible
does not exist on the
proprietary telephone.
Button Assignment.
(☞ Operating Instructions,
1.2 Proprietary Telephone Settings,
“Customising the Buttons on Your
Telephone”)
A tone type single line
telephone (SLT) user
cannot make a call.
There may be something
wrong with a DTMF
receiver.
1. Select “Enable” for DTMF receiver 1
and “Disable” for DTMF receiver 2 in
program [107].
2. Make a call using a tone type SLT
connected to one of extension ports
01–08.
3. If you cannot make the call, the
problem may have been caused by
DTMF receiver 1. If the call can be
made, go to step 4.
4. Try DTMF receiver 2. Select
“Disable” for DTMF receiver 1 and
“Enable” for DTMF receiver 2 in
program [107], and make another call.
If you cannot make the call, the
problem may have been caused by
DTMF receiver 2. If the call can be
made, go to step 5.
5. Check the other 4 DTMF receivers in
the same way. Refer to program
[107].
6-4
Troubleshooting
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 7
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[000] Date and Time Setting
Year
(00 – 99) (Jan. – Dec.) (1 – 31)
’98 Jan.
Month
Day
Day of the week Hour
Minute
(1 – 12) (00 – 59)
12 00
AM / PM
AM
(Sun – Sat)
Thu
Default
Change
1
[002] System Password
Default
Parameter: 4 digits, 0 – 9
1
2
3
4
[003]
[004]
Paired Telephone Assignment for DSS Console
DSS Console Port Assignment
…
…
Selection
Default
DSS 1
DSS console port no. (02 16) / Disable
All: Disable
Paired telephone port no. (01 16) / Disable
DSS 1 – Disable / DSS 2 – Disable
DSS 2
[005] One-Touch Transfer Using a DSS Button
[006] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Changing Mode
Default
Selection
Default
Selection
With Transfer
✓
Manually
✓
Without Transfer
Automatically
[007] Time (Day/Night/Lunch) Service Start Time
Default
Change
Every day Every day
9:00 AM
Sun.
Mon.
Tue.
Wed.
Thu.
Fri.
Sat.
Day
Night
5:30 PM
Lunch-S
Lunch-E
None
None
[008] Operator Assignment
[010] LCD Time Display Selection
Default
Port no.
Default
Selection
Operator
Jack-01
12 HOUR
24 HOUR
✓
7-2
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
SPD no.
Telephone number (32 digits max.)
Name (16 characters max.)
Default
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
All: Not stored
(Continued)
Programming Tables
7-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
SPD no.
Telephone number (32 digits max.)
Name (16 characters max.)
Default
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
All: Not stored
(Continued)
7-4
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[001] System Speed Dialling Entry
[011] System Speed Dialling Name Setting
SPD no.
Telephone number (32 digits max.)
Name (16 characters max.)
Default
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
All: Not stored
Programming Tables
7-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[009] Extension Number Assignment
Plan 2
Selection
Default
Change
Plan 1
Plan 3
✓
…
…
…
Extension no. (200 299)
Change
Extension no. (100 499)
Change
Extension no. (10 49)
Change
Extension
jack no.
Default
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
Default
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
Default
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
[012] Alternative Feature Numbering Plan
CODE no.
Feature no. (10 digits max.)
CODE no.
Feature no. (10 digits max.)
Default: All
Not stored
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
7-6
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[100] Hunting Group Set
…
Default
All
Extension group no. (1 8, : all)
Selection
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Disable
Enable
✓
[101] Hunting Type
Extension group no. (1 8, : all)
…
Default
All
Selection
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Terminate
Circular
✓
[102] Voice Mail Port for KX-TVP100
Default Extn. port no. (07, 08, 15, 16, : all) Default
[107] DTMF Receiver Check
…
DTMF receiver no. (1 6)
Selection
All
07
08
15
16
All
1
2
3
4
5
6
Disable
Enable
✓
✓
[103] DTMF
Integration for
KX-TVP100
[104]
Hold Mode Selection
[105]
Conference Tone
[106] External
Paging Access Tone
Selection
Default
Change
Enable
Disable Hold-1 Hold-2 Hold-3
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
✓
✓
✓
✓
[108] Recall Mode for a
Locked Extension
[109] CO Indicator
Assignment
[110]
Recall Key Mode
Selection
Default
Change
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
MODE 1 MODE 2
✓
✓
✓
[111]
Hold Music Selection
[112] DSS Console
Indication Mode
Selection
Default
Change
External
Tone
Enable
Disable
✓
✓
Programming Tables
7-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[115] Extension Ringing
Pattern Selection
[116]
Conference Pattern Selection
3-Party
C-0 E-3
3-Party
C-1 E-3
3-Party
C-2 E-3
5-Party
C-2 E-5
Selection
Single
Double
Triple
Default
Change
✓
✓
[117]
Call Pickup Tone
[118]
Pulse Restriction
[119] Redialling after
Pulse to Tone Conversion
[120]
Bell Frequency
Selection
Default
Change
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
20 Hz
25 Hz
✓
✓
✓
✓
[121] Automatic Exchange Line
Access Number Selection
[122] Automatic Rotation
for Exchange Line Access
Selection
Default
Change
Dial 0
Dial 9
Enable
Disable
✓
✓
[123]
Break Ratio
[124] SLT Ringing
Mode Selection
[125] Call Barring
[126] DSS
Off-Hook Mode
Check for
and #
Selection
Default
Change
MODE 1 MODE 2
MODE 1
MODE 2
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
✓
✓
✓
✓
[127] Pickup Group Set
Extension group no. (1 8, : all)
…
Default
All
Selection
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Disable
Enable
✓
[200] Hold Recall Time
Selection
Default
Change
30 sec
1 min
1.5 min
2 min
3 min
4 min
5 min
6 min
Disable
✓
[201]
Transfer Recall Time
[202]
[203]
Pickup Dial Delay Time
Call Forwarding Start Time
Selection
Default
Change
15 sec 30 sec 1 min 2 min 5 sec 10 sec 15 sec 20 sec 1 sec 2 sec 3 sec 4 sec
✓
✓
✓
7-8
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[204] Call Duration Count Start Time
Selection
Default
Change
5 sec
10 sec 15 sec 20 sec 25 sec 30 sec 35 sec 40 sec 45 sec 50 sec Instantly
✓
[206]
Dialling Start Time
Selection
Default
Change
0 ms
250 ms 500 ms 750 ms 1000 ms 1250 ms 1500 ms
✓
[207]
[208]
Recall Timing Range Selection
Interdigit Time
Selection
Default
Change
MODE 1 MODE 2 MODE 3 MODE 4 MODE 5
5 sec
10 sec 15 sec 20 sec
✓
✓
[210]
DTMF Time
[211] No Dial
Disconnection
[212] Exchange Line
Duration Time Limit
[213]
Bell Off Detection
…
Selection
Default
Change
MODE 1 MODE 2 Enable
Disable
1
32 minutes
10 minutes
3 sec
6 sec
12 sec
✓
✓
✓
[300] Carrier Excepted Code Assignment
CODE no.
Carrier code (10 digits max.)
CODE no.
Carrier code (10 digits max.)
Default: All
Not stored
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
[301] Call Barring — System Speed Dialling Boundary Class
Selection
Default
Change
Class-1
Class-2
Class-3
Class-4
Class-5
✓
Programming Tables
7-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[302] Call Barring
[303] Call Barring
[304] Call Barring
[305] Call Barring
– Class 2 Denied Codes – Class 3 Denied Codes – Class 4 Denied Codes – Class 5 Denied Codes
CODE no.
Telephone no. (11 digits)
All: Not stored
Default
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
7-10
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[306] Call Barring – Exception Codes
Code no.
Default
01
Telephone no. (11 digits)
Code no.
Telephone no. (11 digits)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Programming Tables
7-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[309] Emergency Dial Number Set
CODE no.
Emergency no. (11 digits max.)
Default
Code-01 = 999, Code-02 = 112, Other codes = Not stored
1
2
3
4
5
[310] Account Codes
CODE no.
Account code (4 digits)
CODE no.
Account code (4 digits)
Default
01
All: Not stored
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
7-12
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[311] Automatic Pause Insertion Codes
CODE no.
Default
01
Pause code (7 digits max.)
CODE no.
Pause code (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
[312] Call Barring – Extension Lock Boundary Class
Default
Change
Disable
COS-2
COS-3
COS-4
COS-5
✓
[350] ARS Selection
Exchange line no. (1 6, : All)
…
Default
All
Selection
1
2
3
4
5
6
Enable
Disable
✓
Programming Tables
7-13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[351] Route 1 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
7-14
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[352] Route 2 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Programming Tables
7-15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[353] Route 3 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
7-16
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[354] Route 4 Selection Codes (Leading Digits)
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Programming Tables
7-17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[355] Route 1 Exception Codes
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
7-18
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[356] Route 2 Exception Codes
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Programming Tables
7-19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[357] Route 3 Exception Codes
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
7-20
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[358] Route 4 Exception Codes
Code no.
Default
01
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
Code no.
Area code no. (7 digits max.)
All: Not stored
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
Programming Tables
7-21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[359] 1st Carrier Selection Code (BT Line Access Code)
Selection
Default
Change
1st carrier access code (4 digits max.)
121 (British Telecom Line access code)
[360] ARS Modification
– Removed Digits
[361] ARS Modification
[364]
ARS Trunk Group
– Added Number
Trunk (TRK) group no.
Deleted digits
Added no. : 20 digits max.
…
(1 6,
)
Route no.
…
…
(0 9)
(0 9, , #)
1
2
3
4
5
6
Default
All routes – 0
Route 1 = 131, Other routes = Not stored
All routes –
1
2
3
4
[362]
[363]
ARS Dial Tone Pattern Selection
ARS Interdigit Time
…
20 seconds
Selection
Default
Change
Disable
Tone 1
Tone 2
Tone 3
1
✓
5 seconds
[381] Route 1
Authorisation Code
[382] Route 2
Authorisation Code
[383] Route 3
Authorisation Code
[384] Route 4
Authorisation Code
Exchange line
no.
…
Authorisation code : 19 digits max. (0 9)
Default
All: Not stored
1
2
3
4
5
6
7-22
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[385]
[386]
[387]
[388]
Route 1 Itemised Bill Route 2 Itemised Bill Route 3 Itemised Bill Route 4 Itemised Bill
Selection Selection Selection Selection
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Exchange line
no.
Default: All
✓
✓
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
[389] Itemised Bill Code Assignment
Extension
port no.
Extension
port no.
…
…
Itemised bill code : 3 digits max. (0 9)
Itemised bill code : 3 digits max. (0 9)
Default
01
Extension ports 01 through 24 = 201 through 224
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
[400] Exchange Line
Connection Assignment
[402] Pulse
Speed Selection
[401] Dial Mode
Selection
Selection
Pulse
Selection
Exchange line no.
Connect
No Connect
DTMF
Call Blocking Low Speed High Speed
Default: All
✓
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
Programming Tables
7-23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[404] Trunk Group
Assignment
[403] Host PBX Access Codes
…
Access codes
(1 or 2 digits, 8 different codes max.)
Trunk group no. (1 6)
Exchange line no.
Default
All: Not stored
Default
Change
1
2
3
4
5
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
—
[405] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Day
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
(All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-24
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[406] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Night
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
* (All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[407] Flexible Outward Dialling Assignment — Lunch
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
(All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-26
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[408] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Day
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
(All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[409] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Night
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
(All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-28
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[410] Flexible Ringing Assignment — Lunch
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
Selection
(All)
Extension
port no.
Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable Enable Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[411] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Day
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
(All)
Extension
port no.
Selection (I: Immediately, 10: 10 seconds delay, 20: 20 seconds delay, 30: 30 seconds delay)
10 20 30
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
Default: All ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-30
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[412] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Night
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
(All)
Extension
port no.
Selection (I: Immediately, 10: 10 seconds delay, 20: 20 seconds delay, 30: 30 seconds delay)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
Default: All ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[413] Delayed Ringing Assignment — Lunch
Exchange line 1 Exchange line 2 Exchange line 3 Exchange line 4 Exchange line 5 Exchange line 6
(All)
Extension
port no.
Selection (I: Immediately, 10: 10 seconds delay, 20: 20 seconds delay, 30: 30 seconds delay)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
10 20 30
Default: All ✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-32
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[414] Exchange Line Mode
— Day
[415] Exchange Line Mode
— Night
[416] Exchange Line Mode
— Lunch
…
Selection — N: Normal, DIL + Extension port no. (01 24), D1: DISA1, D2: DISA2, U: UCD
Exchange line
no.
N
DIL Extn. no. D1 D2
U
N
DIL Extn. no. D1 D2
U
N
DIL Extn. no. D1 D2
U
Default: All
✓
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
[417]
[418]
Pause Time
Recall Time
Selection (milliseconds)
160 300 600
Selection (seconds)
Exchange line no.
1.5
2.5
3.5
4.5
80
100
900
1200
Default: All
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
[419] Automatic Designated
Exchange Line Access
[420] Calling Party
Control (CPC) Signal
[421] CPC Detection
for Outgoing Calls
Selection
Selection
Selection: 00 (Disable),
00 (22 msec) 75 (614 msec)
Exchange line no.
…
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Default: All
✓
00 (Disable)
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
Programming Tables
7-33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[422]
Disconnect Time
[423] Exchange Line
Ringing Pattern Selection
[424] Reverse (Polarity)
Circuit Assignment
Selection (seconds)
Selection
Selection
Exchange line no.
0.5
2.0
4.0
Single
Double
Triple
Enable
Disable
Default: All
✓
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
5
6
[500] DISA Incoming Dialling Mode Selection
Selection
Without AA
With AA
Default
Change
✓
[501] DISA Built-in Auto Attendant
Selection
…
Auto attendant
no.
…
Jack: Extension port no. (01 24)
GRP: Extension group no. (1 8)
Default
All: Not stored
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
7-34
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[502]
[503]
OGM Mode Selection
FAX Connection
…
Selection
Default
Change
MODE 1 MODE 2 MODE 3 MODE 4 MODE 5 MODE 6
Extension port no. (01 24) / Disable
✓
Disable (Not assigned)
[504]
[505]
DISA Delayed Answer Time
DISA Waiting Time after OGM
Selection
Default
Change
0 sec
3 sec
6 sec
12 sec
0 sec
5 sec
10 sec
15 sec
✓
✓
[506]
DISA Busy Mode
[507] DISA
Intercept Mode
[508]
DISA Ringing Time before Intercept
Selection Disconnect Call Waiting DISA 2 Intercept Disconnect 10 sec 20 sec 30 sec 40 sec 60 sec 120 sec
Default
Change
✓
✓
✓
[509]
DISA Ringing Time after Intercept
[510]
DISA No Dial Mode
DISA 1 DISA 2
Intercept Disconnect Intercept Disconnect
Selection
10 sec 20 sec 30 sec 40 sec 60 sec 120 sec
Default
Change
✓
✓
✓
[513]
Cyclic Tone Detection
Selection
Default
Disable 2 Times 3 Times 4 Times
✓
Change
[514] FAX
Tone Detection
[515] Intercept Time
for Internal DISA
[517]
DISA AA Wait Time
Selection
Default
Change
1 Time 2 Times
3 sec
6 sec
9 sec
1 sec
2 sec
3 sec
4 sec
5 sec
✓
✓
✓
Programming Tables
7-35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[516] DISA Incoming Assignment
Selection
Selection
Extension
port no.
Extension
port no.
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Default: All
✓
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
[519]
[520]
UCD Group
DISA OGM Mute Time
…
Selection
Default
Change
0 sec
2 sec
4 sec
6 sec
Extension group no. (1 8)
1
✓
[521]
[522]
[523]
UCD Busy Mode
UCD Busy Waiting Time
UCD OGM Message Interval Time
…
…
Selection
Default
Change
1
32 minutes, 1 59 seconds 30 sec
10 minutes
1 min
1.5 min
2 min
Intercept Disconnect
✓
✓
[524]
[525]
UCD Ringing Time before Intercept
UCD Intercept Mode
Selection
Default
Change
Intercept
Disconnect
10 sec
20 sec
30 sec
40 sec
60 sec
120 sec
✓
✓
[526] UCD Ringing Time after Intercept
Selection
Default
Change
10 sec
20 sec
30 sec
40 sec
60 sec
120 sec
✓
7-36
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[600]
[604]
Extension Group Assignment
Extension Name Setting
…
Extension group no. (1 8)
Extension name
(10 character max.)
Extension
port no.
Default: All – Group 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Default: All – Not stored
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[601] Call Barring – Class of
Service Assignment — Day
[602] Call Barring – Class of
Service Assignment — Night
[603] Call Barring – Class of
Service Assignment — Lunch
…
…
…
COS no. (1 5)
COS no. (1 5)
COS no. (1 5)
Extension
port no.
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-38
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[605]
[606] Call Transfer to [607] Call Forwarding
Account Code Entry Mode
an Exchange Line
to an Exchange Line
Selection
Selection
Selection
Extension
port no.
Verify-Toll
(Call Barring)
Option
Forced
Verify-All
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Programming Tables
7-39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[608] Executive
Busy Override
[609] Do Not
Disturb Override
[610] Parallelled
Telephone Connection
[611]
TAM Extension
Selection
Selection
Selection
Selection
Extension
port no.
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-40
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[612]
[613] Exchange Line
[614]
Room Monitor
Assignment
Duration Time Limit
Selection
Internal Pulse
Detection
Selection
Selection
Selection
Extension
port no.
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
[615] LCD Language Assignment
Selection
Spanish
Selection
Spanish
English
Portuguese
English
Portuguese
Default: All
✓
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
Programming Tables
7-41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[700] Doorphone Ringing
Assignment — Day
[701] Doorphone Ringing
Assignment — Night
[702] Doorphone Ringing
Assignment — Lunch
…
D
1
4: Doorphone no., E: Enable / D: Disable
Extension
port no.
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
7-42
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[703] Door Opener
Assignment — Day
[704] Door Opener
Assignment — Night
[705] Door Opener
Assignment — Lunch
…
1
4: Door opener no., E: Enable / D: Disable
Extension
port no.
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
E
D
Default: All
01
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
[706] Doorphone Ringing
/ Tone Pattern Selection
[707] Doorphone
Access Tone Selection
[708] Doorphone
Ringing Time
Selection
Selection
Selection
Doorphone
no.
Single
Double
Triple
S-Double
Enable
Disable
15 sec
30 sec
Default: All
✓
✓
✓
1
2
3
4
Programming Tables
7-43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
7
Programming Tables
[709] Door Opener Time
Selection
4 sec 5 sec
Door opener
no.
1 sec
2 sec
3 sec
6 sec
7 sec
8 sec
Default: All
✓
1
2
3
4
[800] SMDR RS-232C Communication Parameters
New line
code
Word
Stop
bit
Baud rate
length
Parity
Selection
CR+LF CR 150 300 600 1200 2400 4800 9600
7
8
Mark Space Even Odd None
1
2
Default
Change
✓
✓
✓
✓
✓
[801] SMDR Parameter
[802] Incoming/Outgoing Call Selection for Printing
Default
Selection
Default
Selection
On
Off
On
✓
Page length
(4 99)
66
0
Incoming calls
Outgoing calls
…
✓
Skip perforation
…
(0 95)
Off
Toll
[803] Secret Speed Dialling /
[805]
One-Touch Dialling Printing SMDR Account Code Selection
Selection
Default
Change
No Printing
Printing
CODE
INDEX
✓
✓
[806]
SMDR Language Assignment
Selection
Default
Change
English Spanish Portuguese
✓
7-44
Programming Tables
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
169 mm
ƒ
92.5 mm
185 mm
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copyright:
This manual is copyrighted by Kyushu Matsushita Electric Co., Ltd. (KME). Under the copyright laws, this
manual may not be reproduced in any form, in whole or part, without the prior written consent of KME and its
licensee.
C Kyushu Matsushita Electric Co., Ltd. 1999
Panasonic Business Systems U.K.
Panasonic House, Willoughby Road, Bracknell, Berkshire RG12 8FP
Printed in the United Kingdom
PSQX1708YA KK1099CM0
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Advanced Hybrid System
KX-TA624
Operating Instructions for
the Caller ID Card (KX-TA62493)
In this manual, the suffix of each model number is omitted.
The Caller ID Card supports the following.
It receives the Caller ID service from the Local Exchange. The Caller ID service provides a
display proprietary telephone (KX-T7130) user with the caller’s information, such as the
name and telephone number, on the exchange line assigned to receive Caller ID service
calls. A contract with a Telephone Company is required.
Incoming outside call information from the Caller ID service can be recorded in memory.
Also, the extension user can call back the caller easily by checking the call log.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Contents
Section 1 Installation
1.1 Caller ID Card Installation.................................................................. 1-2
1.2 System Features..................................................................................... 1-4
C
S
Caller ID ............................................................................................. 1-4
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
with the Caller ID Card .................................................................. 1-7
1.3 System Programming............................................................................ 1-8
[900] Caller ID Assignment.............................................................. 1-8
[901] Caller ID Area Code Assignment............................................ 1-8
[902] Caller ID Modification for Local Calls................................... 1-9
[903] Caller ID Modification for Long Distance Calls .................... 1-10
[904] Caller ID Log Priority Selection............................................. 1-11
[906] Caller ID SMDR Format......................................................... 1-11
1.4 Programming Tables............................................................................. 1-12
Section 2 Operations
2.1 Proprietary Telephone Settings............................................................ 2-2
Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone ..................................... 2-2
2.2 Telephone Features................................................................................ 2-4
C
Call Information/Log, Incoming ........................................................ 2-4
Call Log, Incoming............................................................................. 2-5
Electronic Extension Lockout ............................................................ 2-8
E
2.3 Display Example.................................................................................... 2-9
• For proprietary telephone operations, all button illustrations are based on the KX-T7130.
!
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 1
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.1
Caller ID Card Installation
1. Power off the system, and unplug the AC cord.
2. Loosen the screw.
3. Remove the top front cover.
Top front cover
Screw
4. Remove the 2 screws.
Screws
5. Open the bottom front cover.
Bottom front cover
1-2
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.1
Caller ID Card Installation
6. Attach the Caller ID Card.
Caller ID Card
(for exchange lines 1 – 3)
Install the Caller ID Card
(for exchange lines 4 – 6) here.
Note
Please do not damage this part.
7. Insert the flat cable to the connector.
Flat cable
8. Close the cover.
• Be sure the frame of the main unit is connected to the ground (☞ Installation Manual,
2.5 “Frame Ground Connection”).
!
Installation
1-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.2
System Features
Caller ID
Provides a display proprietary telephone (KX-T7130) user with the caller’s information, such
as the name and telephone number, on the exchange line assigned to receive Caller ID
service.
• A contract with a Telephone Company is required.
• An optional Caller ID Card must be installed to the system.
• All 6 exchange lines can be supported by installing 2 Caller ID Cards. One Caller ID
Card supports 3 exchange lines.
!
• System Programming is required to execute this feature.
• A display proprietary telephone user can record the caller’s information
(☞ 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Log, Incoming”). Up to 20 calls can be logged per
extension.
• Only the first 16 digits of the caller’s information can be displayed on the LCD while a
call is being received, or during a conversation. The first 13 digits are displayed when
logged information is shown.
• An assigned name in program [011] “System Speed Dialling Name Setting” will be
displayed when the caller’s telephone number matches one of System Speed Dialling
numbers assigned in program [001] “System Speed Dialling Entry” and a Telephone
Company does not provide the caller’s name.
• If a Telephone Company provides a caller’s name, the name from the Telephone
Company will be displayed even when a name assigned in program [011] is effective.
• If both the number and name are available, the user can select the initial display, number
or name, by program [904] “Caller ID Log Priority Selection”.
• Some Telephone Companies do not provide the caller’s name with the Caller ID service.
• The caller’s telephone number may not be provided in some cases, for example, an
international or mobile telephone call. In this case, the display will show “OUT OF
AREA”, etc.
1-4
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.2
System Features
Flow chart of Caller ID
*1
An outside call is received by the Caller ID line.
With both the caller’
s
number and the name
What is the Caller ID service type
from the Telephone Company ?
With the caller’s number only
*2
No
Is your area code assigned?
Yes
No
Does the caller’s number match your area code?
Yes
<No modification>
*3
*4
Removing and adding the number.
Removing and adding the number.
The reference number has been fixed.
*5
Does the reference number match
a System Speed Dialling number?
No
Yes
*6
Is the matched System Speed Dialling
number assigned the name?
No
Yes
*7
Either the number or the name is displayed.
The number is displayed.
Note: The explanation for *1 through *7 is on the next page.
Installation
1-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.2
System Features
*1: The Caller ID line is assigned in program [900] “Caller ID Assignment”.
*2: Your area code is assigned in program [901] “Caller ID Area Code Assignment”.
*3: The caller’s telephone number is modified according to program [902] “Caller ID Modification
for Local Calls”.
*4: The caller’s telephone number is modified according to program [903] “Caller ID Modification
for Long Distance Calls”.
*5: System Speed Dialling numbers are assigned in program [001] “System Speed Dialling
Entry”. When one of System Speed Dialling numbers includes the reference number, the
system regards them as a match. A line access code (9, 0 or 81 through 86) and/or an account
code assigned in program [310] “Account Codes” in the System Speed Dialling number are
disregarded for the match. The system checks the System Speed Dialling number after a line
access code and/or an account code with the reference number.
*6: Assigning a name to a System Speed Dialling number is in program [011] “System Speed
Dialling Name Setting”.
*7: The user can select the initial display, number or name, by program [904] “Caller ID Log
Priority Selection”. The displayed number is the caller’s telephone number, not the modified
one.
Example (With the caller’s number only):
[901] “Caller ID Area Code Assignment”: 201
[903] “Caller ID Modification for Long Distance Calls”: Deleted digits – 3
Added number – 1
<Caller’s telephone number>
123 456 789
<Modified (reference) number >
1456 789
[001] “System Speed Dialling Entry”: (Speed dialling no. 30)
81 1234 1456789
line access code account code match
[011] “System Speed Dialling Name Setting”: (Speed dialling no. 30) Richard
[904] “Caller ID Log Priority Selection”: Name
<Display>
Richard
• The name and the number can be displayed
alternately by pressing Caller ID Selection button
(☞ 2.1 Proprietary Telephone Settings,
“Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone”,
Caller ID Selection Button (Assignment)).
123456789
1-6
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.2
System Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) with the Caller ID Card
When the Caller ID Card is installed, a received caller’s telephone number (maximum 16
digits) will be printed out after <incoming> or <DISA incoming> as shown below, if the
calling party has enabled Caller ID service. Refer to the Installation Manual, Section 3
Features, “Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)” for more information about SMDR.
An example of a printed call record:
Date
Time
Ext.
CO
Dial number
Duration
Code
31/12/98 12:52PM 203
31/12/98 12:53PM 203
31/12/98 *12:54PM 201
31/12/98 1:04PM 203
31/12/98 1:04PM 202
31/12/98 1:05PM 203
31/12/98 1:06PM 203
31/12/98 1:06PM 202
31/12/98 1:07PM 203
31/12/98 2:15PM 203
31/12/98 2:26PM 203
31/12/98 2:27PM 216
31/12/98 3:25PM
05
02
02
06
05
01
01
02
01
01
01
05
02
12345678901234567890123456789012
00:00'16
00:01'43
. .. .
. .. .
. .. .
4536
. .. .
. .. .
. .. .
. .. .
.. 13
. 201
. .. .
. .. .
. .. .
<
<
incoming
incoming
>2013570846
>1234567890123456 00:07'48
092. . . 1438
<
00:00'06
DISA incoming >2013570846
00:00'09
00:00'08
00:00'08
00:00'17
00:11'00
00:11'00
00:03'00
00:13'55
00:11'48
<
DISA incoming
>
092123456789
0921234567
0921234567
0921234567
F/0927654321
9=0924567123
<
UCD Waiting
>
• A received caller’s telephone number will be printed out only when “With CID” is
selected in program [906] “Caller ID SMDR Format”.
!
• Related Feature References
☞
Installation Manual, Section 3 Features
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR)
Installation
1-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.3
System Programming
[900]-[901]
[900] Caller ID Assignment
Enables or disables the Caller ID feature for each exchange line which has contracted the
Caller ID service from a Telephone Company.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
exchange line no.*
END
SELECT
9
0
0
NEXT
(1···6/
)
(Enable/
To continue
Disable)
SELECT
* Exchange line number: 1 through 6 / (All exchange lines)
Default All exchange lines – Disable
• The exchange lines, if set to “Enable” in this program, always set the DISA Delayed
Answer timer to 6 seconds even if “0 sec” or “3 sec” is selected in program [504] “DISA
Delayed Answer Time”.
!
[901] Caller ID Area Code Assignment
Assigns your area code (up to 5 codes) which is required to use the Caller ID feature. If the
received caller’s number has one of the assigned area codes, it is recognised as a local call.
If the area code is different, it is recognised as a long distance call. By assigning your area
code, the system records the caller’s number modified in programs [902] “Caller ID
Modification for Local Calls” or [903] “Caller ID Modification for Long Distance Calls”.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
STORE
code no.
area code
END
9
0
1
NEXT
(1···5)
6 digits max.
(0···9)
To continue
SELECT
Default
Not stored.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
1-8
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[902]
1.3
System Programming
[902] Caller ID Modification for Local Calls
Assigns the removed digits and added number for a received local call number, which has
one of area codes programmed in [901] “Caller ID Area Code Assignment”. This program
makes the final number which will be recorded in memory. The extension user can call back
the caller easily by checking the call log. Digits are removed from or added to the beginning
of the received number.
< Assigns the deleted digits. >
deleted digits
STORE
END
9
0
2
NEXT
(0···9)
< Assigns the added number. >
added number
If added number
is assigned
STORE
END
4 digits max.
(0···9,#,
)
Example:
[901]: 201
[902]: Deleted digits – 3 / Added number – Not stored
Caller’s number provided by the Local Exchange: 2011234567
Logged (modified) number : 1234567
Default
Deleted digits – 3 / Added number – Not stored.
• Program [901] “Caller ID Area Code Assignment” is required for this program.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
Installation
1-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.3
System Programming
[903]
[903] Caller ID Modification for Long Distance Calls
Assigns the removed digits and added number for a received long distance call number,
which does not have any area codes programmed in [901] “Caller ID Area Code
Assignment”. This program makes the final number which will be recorded in memory.
The extension user can call back the caller easily by checking the call log. Digits are
removed from or added to the beginning of the received number.
< Assigns the deleted digits. >
deleted digits
STORE
END
9
0
3
NEXT
(0···9)
< Assigns the added number. >
If added number
is assigned
added number
STORE
END
4 digits max.
(0···9,#,
)
Example:
[901]: 201
[903]: Deleted digits – 0 (No deletion) / Added number – 1
Caller’s number provided by the Local Exchange: 7149876543
Logged (modified) number
: 17149876543
Default Deleted digits – 0 (No deletion) / Added number – 1
• Program [901] “Caller ID Area Code Assignment” is required for this program.
• To correct a wrong entry, press the CLEAR button and enter the new one.
!
1-10
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[904], [906]
1.3
System Programming
[904] Caller ID Log Priority Selection
Selects the first display of an incoming outside call by the Caller ID service. Either the
name or number can be selected if the Caller ID service supports both the name and number.
or
PREV
NEXT
To continue
extension port no.*
NEXT
END
9
0
4
SELECT
STORE
(01···16/
)
(Name/
To continue
Number)
SELECT
* Extension port number: 01 through 16 / (All extension ports)
Default All extension ports – Name
• This program is available when your Caller ID service provides both the name and number.
If only the number is provided, this program is not necessary.
!
[906] Caller ID SMDR Format
Selects whether a Caller ID number is printed out or not on an SMDR printout.
SELECT
END
STORE
9
0
6
NEXT
(Without CID/
With CID)*
* Without CID (Not printed) / With CID (Printed)
Default With CID
• Even if a name is also sent by the Caller ID service, only the number is printed.
!
Installation
1-11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
1.4
Programming Tables
[900] Caller ID Assignment
…
Default
All
Exchange line no. (1 6, : All)
Selection
1
2
3
4
5
6
Enable
Disable
✓
[901] Caller ID Area Code Assignment
CODE no.
Parameter: 6 digits max., 0 – 9
All: Not stored
Default
1
2
3
4
5
[902] Caller ID Modification
for Local Calls
[903] Caller ID Modification
for Long Distance Calls
Selection
Default
3
Change
Default
0
Change
Number of digits to be deleted
…
(0 9, 0: no deletion)
Number to be added
(4 digits max.)
blank (not stored)
1
[904] Caller ID Log Priority Selection
Selection
Selection
Extension
jack no.
Extension
jack no.
Number
Name
Number
Name
Default: All
✓
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
[906] Caller ID SMDR Format
Selection
Default
Change
Without CID
With CID
✓
1-12
Installation
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Section 2
Operations
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.1
Proprietary Telephone Settings
Customising the Buttons on Your Telephone
Caller ID Indication Button (Assignment)
Allows you to assign a Flexible line key as the Caller ID Indication button. The Caller ID
Indication button can be used in the following cases.
1) Informing you that there is new caller information logged by lighting the indicator
2) Recording caller’s information in memory during a conversation
3) Checking logged caller’s information while on-hook
4) Calling back the logged number
PT
AUTO DIAL
CO
6
STORE
Press the desired Flexible CO button
you wish to assign as the Caller ID
Indication button.
Dial 6.
Press STORE.
<PT Display Example>
CID Indication
• The STORE indicator lights.
• The display shows the initial programming mode.
• Be sure the handset is on the cradle and the SP-PHONE button is off.
• To program, set the MEMORY switch on the proprietary telephone to “PROGRAM”.
• After programming, return the MEMORY switch to the “SET” position.
!
• 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Information/Log, Incoming”
• 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Log, Incoming”
☞
2-2
Operations
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.1
Proprietary Telephone Settings
Caller ID Selection Button (Assignment)
Allows you to assign a Flexible line key as the Caller ID Selection button. The Caller ID
Selection button can be used in the following cases.
1) Confirming a caller’s information while receiving a call or during a conversation
2) Checking the number of logged calls
3) Informing you when no more caller’s information can be logged by lighting the
indicator
PT
AUTO DIAL
CO
7
STORE
Press the desired Flexible CO button
you wish to assign as the Caller ID
Selection button.
Dial 7.
Press STORE.
<PT Display Example>
• The STORE indicator lights.
• The display shows the initial programming
mode.
CID Selection
• Be sure the handset is on the cradle and the SP-PHONE button is off.
• To program, set the MEMORY switch on the proprietary telephone to “PROGRAM”.
• After programming, return the MEMORY switch to the “SET” position.
!
• 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Information/Log, Incoming”
• 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Log, Incoming”
☞
Operations
2-3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Telephone Features
Call Information/Log, Incoming
Provides you with the caller’s telephone number and name simultaneously on the exchange
line assigned to receive Caller ID service calls, if the Caller ID service supports both the
telephone number and name.
If the call is not answered, the call information is automatically recorded in memory
(☞ 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call Log, Incoming”).
Display Operation (— for the KX-T7130 only)
While receiving an incoming call (on-hook) or during a conversation
(off-hook), the display shows the caller’s telephone number or name.
While receiving an incoming call
• If you want to see other information, press the Caller ID
Selection button. The display changes as follows.
JOHN WHITE
(caller’s name)
JOHN WHITE
0111111111
Call on CO 1
(caller’s telephone number)
(CO number)
During a conversation
• Press the Caller ID Selection button to see other information.
The display changes as follows.
JOHN WHITE
(caller’s name)
JOHN WHITE
(caller’s telephone number)
(call duration)
0111111111
CO 2 12:00’30
• The Caller ID Indication button indicator light may turn on when a call is received.
• You can modify and call back the logged numbers. Refer to 2.2 Telephone Features, “Call
Log, Incoming”.
• System Programming determines which is displayed first, the name or number.
• You can program whether to print out a Caller ID number on the SMDR or not by System
Programming.
!
2-4
Operations
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Telephone Features
Call Log, Incoming
If you do not answer a call, your extension (KX-T7130 only) automatically records the
incoming outside call information from the Caller ID service, and the Caller ID Indication
button indicator lights. Up to 20 calls can be logged per extension. When the call log is full
(20 calls are stored), you can select how the twenty-first call is treated. Either a new call can
be disregarded or the new call can overwrite the oldest call that you have already confirmed
(Default: Record the new call.).
You can also modify and call back the logged numbers.
Even if you answer a call, the call information can be recorded by pressing the Caller ID
Indication button during the conversation.
Overwriting the call log
PT
7
3
7
1
#
Confirmation tone
and dial tone
Hang up or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Lift the handset or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Dial 7371.
Dial #.
<PT Display Example>
Incoming Log On
Disregarding the twenty-first call
PT
7
3
7
0
#
Confirmation tone
and dial tone
Hang up or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Lift the handset or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Dial 7370.
Dial #.
<PT Display Example>
Incoming Log Off
Operations
2-5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Telephone Features
Checking
Display Operation (— for the KX-T7130 only)
When the Caller ID Indication button indicator is red, there are new
calls logged.
1. Press the Caller ID Selection button to confirm the number of
logged calls.
<Example>
If there are 2 unchecked calls and 3 checked calls:
New:02 Old:03
• The above information will be displayed for 3 seconds.
2. Press the Caller ID Indication button while on-hook to see the
incoming call information.
01:0111111111
02:0924773333
• The new information that you have not checked will be
displayed first.
3. You can check another caller’s information by pressing the Caller
ID Indication button again.
After displaying all of the new information, the old information you
have already checked will be displayed.
• To modify the telephone number, use the HOLD button to erase
from the first digit. “0 to 9,
add numbers from the first digit.
” can be used to
, # and PAUSE
• To clear the displayed information, press the TRANSFER button.
• To clear all logged call information, go off-hook and press 70 #.
The display shows as follows.
CID Log Clear
• To return to the initial display, go off-hook and on-hook, or wait
for 20 seconds.
• Pressing the Caller ID Selection button provides you with further
information about the party.
The display changes as follows.
<Example>
If the information is stored in log 03,
— caller’s name
— caller’s number
— date and time
03:BOB HANKS
03:0011223344
03:30Oct 09:00PM
• If “OUT OF AREA” is displayed, the call may be from out of
the calling area.
• If “LONG DISTANCE” is displayed, it may be a long distance
call.
• If “PRIVATE” is displayed, the caller chose not to show their
information.
2-6
Operations
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Telephone Features
Calling back
Display Operation (— for the KX-T7130 only)
1. Confirm the number displayed in step 2 or 3 of “Checking” (on the
previous page), and lift the handset or press the SP-PHONE
button.
03:0011223344
2. Press the Caller ID Indication button.
• You may press a line key first to select a specified exchange line.
The last displayed number is dialled.
• When “Disregarding the twenty-first call” has been set and 20 calls are logged, or when
“Overwriting the call log” has been set and all 20 old information has been overwritten, the
Caller ID Selection button indicator lights and informs you that no more calls can be
logged.
PT
!
Operations
2-7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.2
Telephone Features
Electronic Extension Lockout
Allows you to lock your extension so that the “Call Log, Incoming” feature is not shown on
the display when you press the Caller ID Indication button, if you do not want others to see
the information. This feature also prevents others from making outside calls from your
extension.
Locking
PT
same code
lock code lock code
7
7
#
Dial 77.
Dial #. Confirmation tone Hang up or press
Lift the handset or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Enter the 4-digit lock code
(0000 through 9999) twice.
and dial tone.
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
<PT Display Example>
Locked : xxxx
Lock Code
Unlocking
PT
7
7
#
lock code
Dial 77.
Dial #. Confirmation tone Hang up or press
and dial tone.
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Lift the handset or press
SP-PHONE/MONITOR.
Enter the same lock code
you used to lock the extension.
<PT Display Example>
Unlocked
• The operator or manager can cancel this feature for all extensions (Electronic Extension
Lockout — CANCEL ALL).
• “Remote Extension Lock” overrides this feature. If the operator or manager sets Remote
Extension Lock on the extension you have already locked, you cannot unlock it.
PT
PT
!
Operating Instructions, Section 1 Operations
☞
• 1.6 Before Leaving Your Desk, “Locking Your Telephone (Electronic Extension Lockout)”
• 1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Electronic Extension Lockout — CANCEL ALL”
• 1.8 Operator / Manager Service Features, “Remote Extension Lock”
2-8
Operations
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
2.3
Display Example
Due to the Trilingual Selection Feature, you can select the display in English, Spanish or Portuguese by
System Programming. The left part is the English display and the right part is the Spanish display.
ENGLISH DISPLAY
SPANISH DISPLAY
DESCRIPTION
CID Log Clear
RID Despejado
Cleared all logs.
Incoming Log Off Registro ID Off
Cancelled “Incoming Call Log”.
Incoming Log On
Locked:xxxx
New:02 Old:03
Unlocked
Registro ID On
Bloqueado
“Incoming Call Log” is set.
Completed setting “Electronic Extension Lockout”.
Confirming the number of logged calls.
Cancelled “Electronic Extension Lockout”.
Nue:02 Ant:03
Desbloqueada
Operations
2-9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Panasonic Business Systems U.K.
Panasonic House, Willoughby Road, Bracknell, Berkshire RG12 8FP
Printed in the United Kingdom
PSQX1744YA KK1099CM1109SM
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
To expand the sub-menu, left click the
mouse on the symbol, located to the left of
the selected text.
for version 3 Adobe Reader
for version 4 Adobe Reader
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
KX-TA624 Feature / Programming Overview
The KX-TA624 has many new and changed features compared with the KX-T30810 / 61610
This Guide is intended to assist installers who are already familiar with the KX-T30810 / 61610
This Guide clearly shows the Changed and New features of the KX-TA624 with reference to KX-T30810 / 61610.
NEW
Programming (General overview only) :
Main Section
Sub - Sections
Programming
Step
000
001
006
007
SYSTEM FEATURES
DATE / TIME Setting the system clock
SPEED DIAL Setting the System Speed Dials
SYSTEM SWITCHING
Day / Night / Lunch
MODE
TIME
VOICE MAIL INTEGRATION Voice Mail set-up
SYSTEM TIMERS
102 ~ 103
200 ~ 213
400
CO LINE
OUTGOING CALLS
LINE CONNECTED
DIAL MODE
401
402
405 ~ 407
350 ~ 389
408 ~ 410
411 ~ 413
DIAL PULSE SPEED
O/G ASSIGNMENT
ARS (LCR) ASSIGNMENT
INCOMING RINGING MODE
Day [414] / Night [415] / Lunch [416]
NORMAL
I/C Ring Pattern
Delayed Ring
DIL ( Direct In Line )
Must be used for call FWD
Enter Jack
No.
DISA / UCD / FAX / OGM
DSS CONSOLE Assignment
Transfer Mode
500 ~ 526
JACKS
EXTENSIONS
003 ~ 004
005
CALL BARRING (COS) TABLES
COS ASSIGNMENT
EXTENSION GROUPS
300 ~ 312
601 ~ 603
600
FEATURES
604 ~ 615
503
FAX DETECTION ( option required )
TAM EXTENSION ( Telephone Answer Machine )
DOORPHONE / OPENER
611
700 ~ 709
Documentation :
Operating Instructions :
Section 1
Section 2
Operations
Appendix / Troubleshooting
Installation Manual :
Section 1
Section 2
Section 3
Section 4
Section 5
Section 6
Section 7
Basic System Construction
Installation of System and all Options
Feature descriptions
System Programming steps
Default Tables for program steps
Troubleshooting Guide
Customer Data Programming Tables
Programming note :
System Programming :
A Programming Password has replaced the PBX Program Switch ( KX-T30810/61610 )
( Password Default Setting : ‘* # 1 2 3 4’ )
Details in the Installation Manual ( Page 4 - 2 )
Data Clear Switch :
An internal ‘Data Clear’ switch has been added to the CPU board.
Operation described in the Installation Manual ( Page 2 - 34 )
( 1 of 6 )
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CURRENT & CHANGED Programming Steps
( with reference to the KX-T30810 / 61610 )
KX-T
30810
KX-T
61610
KX-TA
624
Description
Changed or Enhanced
Features
00
01
00
01
02
000
001
003
004
Date / Time
System Speed Dial
DSS Console Assignment
DSS Console and Paired Telephone
Assignment are now separate steps
-
DSS Console
Pair Telephone No.
Dial Mode
03
04
401
‘Call Blocking’ has been added
i.e. DTMF is not sent to a pulse mode
CO line when dialling from a MF
telephone.
DTMF / Pulse
04
05
05
06
006
System Switching Mode
Automatic / Manual
007
System Switching Time
‘Day of week’ & ‘Lunch
Start / End’ times added
Day / Night / Lunch
06
07
07
08
405
406
Flexible Outward Dialling - Day
Flexible Outward Dialling - Night
Flexible Outward Dialling - Lunch
Flexible Ringing Assignment - Day
Flexible Ringing Assignment - Night
Flexible Ringing Assignment - Lunch
Call Barring Class Assignment - Day
Call Barring Class Assignment - Night
Call Barring Class Assignment - Lunch
Call Barring - Deny Codes
407
‘Lunch’ Mode added
-
08
-
09
408
09
10
409
410
‘Lunch’ Mode added
COS assignment added for
Day / Night / Lunch
Modes
-
10
-
11
601
12
602
603
11
33
14
13
14
16
17
302 ~ 305
COS levels 4 & 5 added
306
Call Barring - Allow Codes
Automatic Answer Mode
COS levels 4 & 5 added
Set by extension user
(Operating Instructions Page 1-35)
-
403
-
Host PBX Access Codes
-
-
19
Ext. / CO
Programmable Call Waiting
Set by extension user
( Operating Instructions Page 1-45 )
20
411
412
Delayed Ringing Assignment - Day
Delayed Ringing Assignment - Night
Delayed Ringing Assignment - Lunch
Delayed Ringing count
Delayed Ringing assignment added
-
for each mode
413
21
22
411 ~ 413
Included in Program Steps 411 ~ 413
-
21
Intercom Alert Tone ( Voice / Tone )
Set by extension user
(Operating Instructions Page 1-82)
-
22
23
700
701
Doorphone Ringing Assignment - Day
Doorphone Ringing Assignment - Night
Doorphone Ringing Assignment - Lunch
Dial Call Pickup
Doorphone Ringing assignment
added for each mode
702
23
17
24
26
27
29
127
Sets the Pickup Groups for Extns.
204
Call Duration Count Start Timer
SMDR Communication Parameters
SMDR Incoming / Outgoing Selection
800 ~ 801
802
-
-
( 2 of 6)
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CURRENT & CHANGED Programming Steps
( with reference to the KX-T30810 / 61610 )
KX-T
30810
KX-T
61610
KX-TA
624
Description
Changed or Enhanced
Features
25
26
27
29
30
31
32
33
Hold Time Reminder
Preset to 15 secs
-
200
Hold Recall Time Set
106
External Pager Access Tone
Programmable Secret Speed Dials
Separate ‘Secret’ table not provided
Refer to ‘Secret Dialling’
-
( Installation Manual Page 3 – 62 )
18
19
20
-
34
35
36
37
418
422
420
005
Recall Time
No Earth Recall Option
Disconnect Time
Calling Party Control
DSS Button Mode
With / Without transfer
28
12
38
39
107
201
DTMF Receiver Check
Transfer Recall Time
More time options added
( 15secs / 30secs / 1 min / 2mins )
40
-
F3 / FWD Key
Sets F3 to a FWD Key
Set by extension user
(Operating Instructions Page 1-12)
-
31
-
42
43
419
Automatic CO Line access Outgoing
Programmable Call Waiting Tone Type
Set by extension user
(Operating Instructions Page 1-7)
-
34
703
704
Door Opener Assignment - Day
Door Opener Assignment - Night
Door Opener Assignment - Lunch
ARS Enable / Disable
Door Opening can now be
-
assigned for each Mode
705
70
70
71
350
Enabled on an individual CO basis
351 ~ 354
300
First Digit of ARS Code
-
-
Carrier Excepted Codes, disregards codes when
applying ARS or Call Barring
i.e. Call blocking code (*141)
-
71
72
355 ~ 358
381 ~ 384
Carrier Codes Assignment
Stored Carrier Codes are disregarded
72
73
73
75
Authorisation Code
Carrier Access Code
Sets the Access Code
-
360
ARS Modification – Remove Digits
ARS Modification – Added Digits
ARS Dial Tone Pattern
ARS Interdigit Time
Removes digits before sending
Adds digits before the dialled number
Selects the Dial Tone generated
Assigns the wait time for ARS
Assigns the trunk group used by ARS
361
362
-
-
-
-
363
364
ARS Trunk Group
-
-
74
74
385 ~ 388
389
Itemised Bill by Extension
Assigns the Bill code to each Extension
BT Access Code
75
98
76
98
359
Station Program Clear
Set by Extension user
(Operating Instructions Page 1-7)
99
99
999
System Data Clear
( 3 of 6 )
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
NEW Programming Steps
( with reference to the KX-T30810 / 61610 )
Step Program Title
Feature Description
Default
002
System Password
Replaces the PBX Programming Switch
( Installation Manual Page 4 –3 )
* #
: System Prog
1234 : Password
008
009
Operator Assignment
Assigns the System Operator Telephone
Jack : 01
Extension Number Assignment
Allows the extension numbering scheme to be changed
Jack 01 ( Ext. 201 )
24 ( Ext. 224 )
12 HOUR
010
011
012
100
101
102
LCD Time Display Selection
Speed Dial Number Set
Alternative Feature Number Plan
Hunt Group
12 / 24 hour clock display options
Used for Speed Dials and Call ID Feature
Replaces feature with a code 50 ~ 59
Not stored
Not stored
Enables Station Hunting for Extension Groups
Assigns Hunting Type for Extension Groups
All groups : Disabled
All groups : Terminate
Station Hunt Type
Voice Mail Port
Enables Jacks ( assigned as Voice Mail Ports )
to send DTMF signalling to Voice Mail
Enables signalling of Call Status information to
Voice Mail ports ( busy, answered, ringing, etc. )
Assigns Call Hold Mode for SLT extensions
( Example - HOLD 1 : Recall + on-hook )
Confirmation Tone sent at the Start and End
of a Conference Call
Allows locked extensions to send a Recall signal whilst
talking to an external call
Allows an extension, not programmed to ring
[408 – 410]
Jacks 07 / 08 / 15 / 16 :
Disabled
Disabled
103
104
105
108
109
Voice Mail Port
DTMF Integration
Hold Mode Selection
HOLD 1
Conference Tone
Enable ( send )
Disabled ( not allowed )
Enable ( Allow )
Recall Mode of a Station Locked
Extension
CO Indicator Assignment
to receive the call by pressing the CO Line button
Mode1: Sends Recall signal time ( Prog. Step 418 )
Mode2: Recall signal is sent while the button is pressed
Assigns External Music or Tone (Beep)
110
111
112
Recall Key Mode
Mode 1
Hold Music Selection
External Music / Tone
DSS Console Indication Mode
( for FWD / DND )
External Music
Enable ( Flashing )
Assigns if an extension set as FWD/DND
shows as a flashing button on the BLF/ DSS
115
116
117
Extension Ringing Pattern Selection
Conference Pattern Selection
Call Pick-up Tone
Sets Single / Double / Triple Ring Pattern
Single
Set the max. number of parties in a conference
5 party (C-2 E-5)
Enabled ( Tone )
Confirmation tone sent
when the Call Pickup feature is used
118
119
Pulse Restriction
Enables / Disables pulses being sent to the CO Line
during a conversation
( when Call Block is set in program step 401 )
Allows Redial to use tone dialling on a pulse CO Line
if the call had used * and # to convert to Tone
Sets the Bell Frequency for an SLT device
Enable
Disable
Redialling after Pulse / Tone
conversion
Bell Frequency
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
202
25 Hz
Automatic Line Access Number
Auto Rotation of Line Access
Break Ratio
If set at ‘0’ Operator call becomes ‘9’
Auto rotation of CO lines seized
Dial 9
Disabled (no rotate)
Mode 1 (66%)
Mode 2 (3 sec)
Enable ( Check )
Enable
Sets the break ratio to CO lines
SLT Ring Mode
Length of SLT Ring Cycle
Call Barring Check for * , #
DSS Off-Hook Mode
Call Forward Start Time
Assigns if * and # are checked by the COS program
Making Intercom call by pressing DSS key
Call FWD no answer timer
15 secs
Options : 5 / 10 / 15 / 20 secs
203
206
Pickup Dial Delay Time
( Hot Telephone )
Dial Start Time
Auto Dial time delay
Options : 1 / 2 / 3 / 4 secs
Time between seizing a CO Line and digits being sent
Range : 0 ~ 1500 milliseconds
Sets the Range for Extensions - SLT
3 secs
0 mS
207
208
Recall Timing Range
Interdigit Time
Mode 1 (50 ~ 180 mS)
Maximum time allowed between digits when dialling
out. Options : 5 / 10 / 15 secs
20 secs
(Prior to disconnection )
210
DTMF Time
Assigns the minimum duration
Mode 1 (80 mS)
( 4 of 6)
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
NEW Programming Steps
( with reference to the KX-T30810 / 61610 )
Step Program Title
Feature Description
Default
211
No Dial Disconnection
Call disconnects if 1st Digit is not dialled
within 20 seconds of seizing a CO Line
Sets maximum CO call time (Enabled Prog 613)
Enable
( disconnect )
10 mins
212
213
301
CO Line Duration Limit
Bell Off Detection
Sets the wait time between bell signals from CO line
3 secs
Call Barring – System Speed Dial
Boundary Class
Assigns the call barring class for System Speed Dial
Numbers
Class 1
309
Emergency Dial Number Set
Stored ‘Emergency’ telephone numbers override the
following : ‘COS Level’ / ‘Account Code Modes’ /
‘Electronic Extension Lock’
Locations
01 : 999 02 : 112
03 ~ 05 : Not stored
01 ~ 24 : Not stored
i.e. 01 : 1234
01 ~ 40 : Not Stored
i.e. 01 : 1234567
310
311
Account Codes
Assigns Account Codes for ‘Verify - All’ mode
Automatic Pause Insertion Codes
40 codes can be assigned as Pause Codes.
Pause [ duration prog. step 417 ] is inserted after the
code
312
Call Barring – Extension Lock
COS level applied to Locked Extensions
Options : COS Levels 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / Disabled
Defines connected CO’s
Disabled
400
402
CO Line Connected Assignment
Pulse Speed Selection
CO 1 ~ 6 : Connected
10 pps
Sets CO Line ‘Pulse Speed’
Options : 10 / 20 pps
404
CO Line Group Assignment
Trunk Group assignment of CO’s
CO 1 : Trunk Group 1
through to
CO 6 : Trunk Group 6
414
to
416
Outside Line Mode
( Day / Night / Lunch )
NORMAL : Follows programming steps 408 ~ 410
NORMAL
DIL
: Assigns one ext. to receive I/C CO call
(must be used if Call FWD is required)
DISA1
DISA2
UCD
: The caller will hear a Tone or OGM
: The caller will hear two different OGM
: Call will be rec’d via UCD function
417
421
Pause Time
Assigns the Host PBX pause time
1.5 secs
Disable
CPC Detection for Outgoing Calls
Enables CPC detection during an outside call.
If CPC is detected, the system disconnects the line
( disconnection time Program Step 420 )
Incoming CO Line ringing pattern
Options : Single / Double / Triple Ring
Detects CO Line reversal
423
CO Line Ringing Pattern Selection
Reverse (Polarity) Check
Double
424
500
Disabled
DISA Incoming Dialling Mode
Selection - Auto Attendant
DISA Built-in Auto Attendant
Without AA System accepts : Ext. / Access No.
Without AA
With AA
System accepts : Ext. / Access / AA No.
501
502
503
504
505
Assigns Auto Attendant numbers ‘0 ~ 9’
to extension jacks
Mode 1 ~ 6 DISA or UCD functions can be used
to receive IC calls
Assigns an extension to receive FAX calls
when CNG is detected
Assigns delay in DISA answering a call
Options : 0 / 3 / 6 / 12 secs
0 ~ 9 : Not stored
i.e. 0 : Jack 01
Mode 1
OGM Mode Selection
( KX-TA 62491 required )
FAX Connection
( KX-TA 62491 required )
All Jacks : Disabled
3 secs
DISA Delayed Answer Time
DISA Waiting Time after OGM
Selects time the system waits for DTMF
or CNG tone after OGM played
5 secs
Options : 0 / 5 / 10 / 15 secs
506
507
508
509
510
DISA Busy Mode
Sets DISA response to a dialled busy extensions
Options : Call waiting / Disconnect / play OGM 2
Sets DISA response to unanswered calls
Options : Disconnect / Intercept
Sets DISA Intercept time for unanswered calls
Options : 10 / 20 / 30 / 40 / 60 / 120secs
Sets the ring time at the Intercept destination
Options : 10 / 20 / 30 / 40 / 60 / 120secs
Selects action taken by DISA if no response is received
after OGM ( e.g. DTMF or CNG )
Options : Intercept / Disconnect
Disconnect
Intercept
20 secs
DISA Intercept Mode
Disconnect / Intercept
DISA Ring Time before Intercept
DISA Ring time After Intercept
DISA No Dial Mode
20 secs
DISA1 : Intercept
DISA2 : Intercept
513
Cyclic Tone Detection
( OGM option KX-TA62491 required )
Sets the number of times Cyclic Tone has to be detected 4 times
before the system regards the call as complete
Options : Disable ( does not detect ) / 2 / 3 / 4 times
( 5 of 6 )
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
NEW Programming Steps
( with reference to the KX-T30810 / 61610 )
Step Program Title
Feature Description
Default
514
Fax Tone Detection
( KX-TA62491 option required )
Sets the number of times the FAX / CNG tone has to be 1 Time
detected
Options : 1 / 2 Times
515
516
517
Intercept Time for Internal DISA
DISA Incoming Assignment
DISA AA Wait Time
Sets intercept time for an internal DISA call
Options : 3 / 6 / 9 secs
Assigns which extensions can receive DISA calls
3 secs
All jacks : Enable
(accept)
Sets AA second digit wait time
2 secs
If no digit received within this time call is routed by
program step 501. Options : 1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 secs
Assigns the wait time after answering
519
520
521
522
523
524
525
526
600
604
605
DISA Mute Time
0 secs
UCD Group
Assigns the Extension Group for UCD
Assigns the Time the UCD holds an IC call
Assigns the Time between messages
Group 1
10 min
UCD Busy Waiting Time
UCD OGM Message Interval Time
UCD Busy Mode
1 min
Assigns the operation after [521] Timer expires
Assigns the operation when [525] Timer expires
Assigns the UCD Extensions No Answer time
Assigns the Ring time after intercept
Intercept
Intercept
20 secs
UCD Intercept Time
UCD Ring Time before Intercept
UCD Ring Time after Intercept
Extension Groups
20 secs
All jacks : Group 1
Not stored
Option
Sets Extension groups (used for Hunting)
Assigns a name to an extension
Extension Name Setting
Account Code Entry Mode
Option / Forced / Verify - All
Verify – Toll
Selects the Account code input mode
Optional/Forced/Verify – All : Set if code must be used
Verify – Toll : Temporarily changes COS to level 2
Permits call transfer to a CO Line
606
607
608
609
610
Call Transfer to CO Line
All jacks : Disabled
All jacks : Disabled
All jacks : Disabled
All jacks : Disabled
All jacks : Disabled
Call Forward To CO Line
Executive Busy Override
Do Not Disturb Override
Parallel Connection
Permits calls to be forwarded to a CO Line
Allows a call to barge an established call
Permits the Do Not Disturb Override function
Permits an SLT to be connected in parallel with a
Proprietary Telephone
611
612
TAM Extension
( Telephone Answering Machine )
Room Monitor Assignment
Assigns TAM extension
Allows Call Retrieval feature
Assigns which jacks can be monitored by another
proprietary telephone
All jacks : Disabled
All jacks : Disabled
613
614
615
706
Exchange Line Duration Limit
Internal Pulse Detection
Limits the max. time for Extensions
Disabled
Disables Pulse Detection from Extensions
Set the LCD Display language
Enabled
LCD Language Assignment
Doorphone Ringing Tone / Pattern
All jacks : English
Triple
Doorphone ringing pattern
Options : Single / Double / Triple Ring
Assigns if a tone is sent to the Doorphone when
it is monitored
Doorphone ringing time
Options : 15 / 30 secs
Door unlocked time
Options : 1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 secs
Enables or disables SMDR printout for these numbers
707
708
709
803
Doorphone Access Tone Selection
Doorphone Ring Time
Doorphones 1 ~ 4 :
Enable (send tone)
15 secs
Door Opener Time
Doorphones
1 ~ 4 : 5 secs
No printing
Secret Speed Dialling / One Touch
Dial Printing
804
805
System Data Dump
Outputs all System Data to SMDR
SMDR Account Code Selection
Sets SMDR Account Code printout
CODE : Account code
CODE
INDEX : The two digit account code location
806
998
SMDR Language Selection
ROM Version
Set SMDR Language
English
Confirms the System ROM version
No Default
( 6 of 6)
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|
Milwaukee Saw 2429 20 User Manual
Multiquip Portable Generator DCA250SSIU User Manual
Murray Lawn Mower 405000x8B User Manual
NEC Computer Monitor FP1350 FP950 User Manual
Nokia Cell Phone 1110i User Manual
NuTone Fan QT150 User Manual
Oki Printer 6200n User Manual
Panasonic Power Supply EZAEG2A User Manual
Panasonic Security Camera GP KS822CU User Manual
Panasonic Vacuum Cleaner MC E455 User Manual